Mercurial > hg
annotate mercurial/helptext/config.txt @ 50207:f35cf52acabd
delta-find: rename `delta-reuse-policy` to `pulled-delta-reuse-policy`
This make it clearer which type of delta we are talking about.
author | Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net> |
---|---|
date | Thu, 23 Feb 2023 15:32:27 +0100 |
parents | bcae90c53def |
children | 4341c2271d67 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
1 The Mercurial system uses a set of configuration files to control |
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
2 aspects of its behavior. |
9785
b52f0f221325
help: add "hg help config" topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
3 |
26365
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
4 Troubleshooting |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
5 =============== |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
6 |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
7 If you're having problems with your configuration, |
47071
3e381eb557f3
config: add --source option to include source of value
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46972
diff
changeset
|
8 :hg:`config --source` can help you understand what is introducing |
26365
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
9 a setting into your environment. |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
10 |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
11 See :hg:`help config.syntax` and :hg:`help config.files` |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
12 for information about how and where to override things. |
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
13 |
27607
ee27d461bf5b
help: rename the Format section to Structure
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27606
diff
changeset
|
14 Structure |
ee27d461bf5b
help: rename the Format section to Structure
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27606
diff
changeset
|
15 ========= |
26365
33af0c53aeff
help: add config.troubleshooting section at the top
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26313
diff
changeset
|
16 |
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
17 The configuration files use a simple ini-file format. A configuration |
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
18 file consists of sections, led by a ``[section]`` header and followed |
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
19 by ``name = value`` entries:: |
9785
b52f0f221325
help: add "hg help config" topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
20 |
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
21 [ui] |
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
22 username = Firstname Lastname <firstname.lastname@example.net> |
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
23 verbose = True |
9785
b52f0f221325
help: add "hg help config" topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
24 |
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
25 The above entries will be referred to as ``ui.username`` and |
26280
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
26 ``ui.verbose``, respectively. See :hg:`help config.syntax`. |
9785
b52f0f221325
help: add "hg help config" topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
27 |
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
28 Files |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
29 ===== |
9785
b52f0f221325
help: add "hg help config" topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
30 |
14460
d5f616132c10
doc: improve merge between hgrc.5 and config help topic
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14458
diff
changeset
|
31 Mercurial reads configuration data from several files, if they exist. |
13955
86b5cc1e8be8
help config: explain that config files do not exist by default
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
11408
diff
changeset
|
32 These files do not exist by default and you will have to create the |
27762
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
33 appropriate configuration files yourself: |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
34 |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
35 Local configuration is put into the per-repository ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc`` file. |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
36 |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
37 Global configuration like the username setting is typically put into: |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
38 |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
39 .. container:: windows |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
40 |
27960
0ec12435b78b
doc: itemize text blocks to increase readability in HTML format
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
27949
diff
changeset
|
41 - ``%USERPROFILE%\mercurial.ini`` (on Windows) |
27762
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
42 |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
43 .. container:: unix.plan9 |
70e7bfebba46
help: split config user settings file by platform
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27761
diff
changeset
|
44 |
27960
0ec12435b78b
doc: itemize text blocks to increase readability in HTML format
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
27949
diff
changeset
|
45 - ``$HOME/.hgrc`` (on Unix, Plan9) |
13955
86b5cc1e8be8
help config: explain that config files do not exist by default
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
11408
diff
changeset
|
46 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
47 The names of these files depend on the system on which Mercurial is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
48 installed. ``*.rc`` files from a single directory are read in |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
49 alphabetical order, later ones overriding earlier ones. Where multiple |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
50 paths are given below, settings from earlier paths override later |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
51 ones. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
52 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
53 .. container:: verbose.unix |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
54 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
55 On Unix, the following files are consulted: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
56 |
46007
aa4440e59c44
helptext: mention in `hg help config` that `.hg/hgrc-not-shared` is consulted
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
45866
diff
changeset
|
57 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc-not-shared`` (per-repository) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
58 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc`` (per-repository) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
59 - ``$HOME/.hgrc`` (per-user) |
30941
354020079723
hg: allow usage of XDG_CONFIG_HOME/hg/hgrc
David Demelier <demelier.david@gmail.com>
parents:
30766
diff
changeset
|
60 - ``${XDG_CONFIG_HOME:-$HOME/.config}/hg/hgrc`` (per-user) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
61 - ``<install-root>/etc/mercurial/hgrc`` (per-installation) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
62 - ``<install-root>/etc/mercurial/hgrc.d/*.rc`` (per-installation) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
63 - ``/etc/mercurial/hgrc`` (per-system) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
64 - ``/etc/mercurial/hgrc.d/*.rc`` (per-system) |
43669
8273680059b2
help: remove references to default.d/ from user-facing docs
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
43632
diff
changeset
|
65 - ``<internal>/*.rc`` (defaults) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
66 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
67 .. container:: verbose.windows |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
68 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
69 On Windows, the following files are consulted: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
70 |
46007
aa4440e59c44
helptext: mention in `hg help config` that `.hg/hgrc-not-shared` is consulted
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
45866
diff
changeset
|
71 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc-not-shared`` (per-repository) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
72 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc`` (per-repository) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
73 - ``%USERPROFILE%\.hgrc`` (per-user) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
74 - ``%USERPROFILE%\Mercurial.ini`` (per-user) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
75 - ``%HOME%\.hgrc`` (per-user) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
76 - ``%HOME%\Mercurial.ini`` (per-user) |
43952
14d282b57e24
help: clarify that the Windows registry key for hgrc files is systemwide
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43951
diff
changeset
|
77 - ``HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Mercurial`` (per-system) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
78 - ``<install-dir>\hgrc.d\*.rc`` (per-installation) |
26625
adae8928fe09
windows: read all global config files, not just the first (issue4491) (BC)
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
26623
diff
changeset
|
79 - ``<install-dir>\Mercurial.ini`` (per-installation) |
43951
1ccf340acf14
windows: add a global equivalent to /etc/mercurial for *.rc processing
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43873
diff
changeset
|
80 - ``%PROGRAMDATA%\Mercurial\hgrc`` (per-system) |
1ccf340acf14
windows: add a global equivalent to /etc/mercurial for *.rc processing
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43873
diff
changeset
|
81 - ``%PROGRAMDATA%\Mercurial\Mercurial.ini`` (per-system) |
1ccf340acf14
windows: add a global equivalent to /etc/mercurial for *.rc processing
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43873
diff
changeset
|
82 - ``%PROGRAMDATA%\Mercurial\hgrc.d\*.rc`` (per-system) |
43669
8273680059b2
help: remove references to default.d/ from user-facing docs
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
43632
diff
changeset
|
83 - ``<internal>/*.rc`` (defaults) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
84 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
85 .. note:: |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
86 |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
87 The registry key ``HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Mercurial`` |
19183
9d88916fb56f
help/config: note 64-bit Windows registry key used with 32-bit Python
Mike Williams <mrw@eandem.co.uk>
parents:
19050
diff
changeset
|
88 is used when running 32-bit Python on 64-bit Windows. |
9d88916fb56f
help/config: note 64-bit Windows registry key used with 32-bit Python
Mike Williams <mrw@eandem.co.uk>
parents:
19050
diff
changeset
|
89 |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
90 .. container:: verbose.plan9 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
91 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
92 On Plan9, the following files are consulted: |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
93 |
46007
aa4440e59c44
helptext: mention in `hg help config` that `.hg/hgrc-not-shared` is consulted
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
45866
diff
changeset
|
94 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc-not-shared`` (per-repository) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
95 - ``<repo>/.hg/hgrc`` (per-repository) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
96 - ``$home/lib/hgrc`` (per-user) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
97 - ``<install-root>/lib/mercurial/hgrc`` (per-installation) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
98 - ``<install-root>/lib/mercurial/hgrc.d/*.rc`` (per-installation) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
99 - ``/lib/mercurial/hgrc`` (per-system) |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
100 - ``/lib/mercurial/hgrc.d/*.rc`` (per-system) |
43669
8273680059b2
help: remove references to default.d/ from user-facing docs
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
43632
diff
changeset
|
101 - ``<internal>/*.rc`` (defaults) |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
102 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
103 Per-repository configuration options only apply in a |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
104 particular repository. This file is not version-controlled, and |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
105 will not get transferred during a "clone" operation. Options in |
27760
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
106 this file override options in all other configuration files. |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
107 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
108 .. container:: unix.plan9 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
109 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
110 On Plan 9 and Unix, most of this file will be ignored if it doesn't |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
111 belong to a trusted user or to a trusted group. See |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
112 :hg:`help config.trusted` for more details. |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
113 |
27889
88aa4da0cba8
help: move Windows 9x information to appropriate place
Danek Duvall <danek.duvall@oracle.com>
parents:
27762
diff
changeset
|
114 Per-user configuration file(s) are for the user running Mercurial. Options |
88aa4da0cba8
help: move Windows 9x information to appropriate place
Danek Duvall <danek.duvall@oracle.com>
parents:
27762
diff
changeset
|
115 in these files apply to all Mercurial commands executed by this user in any |
88aa4da0cba8
help: move Windows 9x information to appropriate place
Danek Duvall <danek.duvall@oracle.com>
parents:
27762
diff
changeset
|
116 directory. Options in these files override per-system and per-installation |
88aa4da0cba8
help: move Windows 9x information to appropriate place
Danek Duvall <danek.duvall@oracle.com>
parents:
27762
diff
changeset
|
117 options. |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
118 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
119 Per-installation configuration files are searched for in the |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
120 directory where Mercurial is installed. ``<install-root>`` is the |
27760
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
121 parent directory of the **hg** executable (or symlink) being run. |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
122 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
123 .. container:: unix.plan9 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
124 |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
125 For example, if installed in ``/shared/tools/bin/hg``, Mercurial |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
126 will look in ``/shared/tools/etc/mercurial/hgrc``. Options in these |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
127 files apply to all Mercurial commands executed by any user in any |
df4894651532
help: split out unix/plan9 config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27759
diff
changeset
|
128 directory. |
22586
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
129 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
130 Per-installation configuration files are for the system on |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
131 which Mercurial is running. Options in these files apply to all |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
132 Mercurial commands executed by any user in any directory. Registry |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
133 keys contain PATH-like strings, every part of which must reference |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
134 a ``Mercurial.ini`` file or be a directory where ``*.rc`` files will |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
135 be read. Mercurial checks each of these locations in the specified |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
136 order until one or more configuration files are detected. |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
137 |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
138 Per-system configuration files are for the system on which Mercurial |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
139 is running. Options in these files apply to all Mercurial commands |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
140 executed by any user in any directory. Options in these files |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
141 override per-installation options. |
6e5657ce9e8c
help: use OS containers for config file lists
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
22550
diff
changeset
|
142 |
23142
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
143 Mercurial comes with some default configuration. The default configuration |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
144 files are installed with Mercurial and will be overwritten on upgrades. Default |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
145 configuration files should never be edited by users or administrators but can |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
146 be overridden in other configuration files. So far the directory only contains |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
147 merge tool configuration but packagers can also put other default configuration |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
148 there. |
c4ce077588d0
config: introduce "built-in" default configuration settings in default.d
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
23121
diff
changeset
|
149 |
46345
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
150 On versions 5.7 and later, if share-safe functionality is enabled, |
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
151 shares will read config file of share source too. |
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
152 `<share-source/.hg/hgrc>` is read before reading `<repo/.hg/hgrc>`. |
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
153 |
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
154 For configs which should not be shared, `<repo/.hg/hgrc-not-shared>` |
043781c0ffd6
doc: remove the section about share-safe from its verbose gating
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46344
diff
changeset
|
155 should be used. |
46008
ecef004c6410
helptext: document share safe functionality in `hg help config -v`
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46007
diff
changeset
|
156 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
157 Syntax |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
158 ====== |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
159 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
160 A configuration file consists of sections, led by a ``[section]`` header |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
161 and followed by ``name = value`` entries (sometimes called |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
162 ``configuration keys``):: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
163 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
164 [spam] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
165 eggs=ham |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
166 green= |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
167 eggs |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
168 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
169 Each line contains one entry. If the lines that follow are indented, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
170 they are treated as continuations of that entry. Leading whitespace is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
171 removed from values. Empty lines are skipped. Lines beginning with |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
172 ``#`` or ``;`` are ignored and may be used to provide comments. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
173 |
14651
e9e4e9ab62bd
help/config: fix 'Mercurial' casing
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14460
diff
changeset
|
174 Configuration keys can be set multiple times, in which case Mercurial |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
175 will use the value that was configured last. As an example:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
176 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
177 [spam] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
178 eggs=large |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
179 ham=serrano |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
180 eggs=small |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
181 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
182 This would set the configuration key named ``eggs`` to ``small``. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
183 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
184 It is also possible to define a section multiple times. A section can |
14652
73cb35f6fd78
help/config: do not refer to config files as hgrc files
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14651
diff
changeset
|
185 be redefined on the same and/or on different configuration files. For |
73cb35f6fd78
help/config: do not refer to config files as hgrc files
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14651
diff
changeset
|
186 example:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
187 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
188 [foo] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
189 eggs=large |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
190 ham=serrano |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
191 eggs=small |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
192 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
193 [bar] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
194 eggs=ham |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
195 green= |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
196 eggs |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
197 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
198 [foo] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
199 ham=prosciutto |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
200 eggs=medium |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
201 bread=toasted |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
202 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
203 This would set the ``eggs``, ``ham``, and ``bread`` configuration keys |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
204 of the ``foo`` section to ``medium``, ``prosciutto``, and ``toasted``, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
205 respectively. As you can see there only thing that matters is the last |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
206 value that was set for each of the configuration keys. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
207 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
208 If a configuration key is set multiple times in different |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
209 configuration files the final value will depend on the order in which |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
210 the different configuration files are read, with settings from earlier |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
211 paths overriding later ones as described on the ``Files`` section |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
212 above. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
213 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
214 A line of the form ``%include file`` will include ``file`` into the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
215 current configuration file. The inclusion is recursive, which means |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
216 that included files can include other files. Filenames are relative to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
217 the configuration file in which the ``%include`` directive is found. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
218 Environment variables and ``~user`` constructs are expanded in |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
219 ``file``. This lets you do something like:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
220 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
221 %include ~/.hgrc.d/$HOST.rc |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
222 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
223 to include a different configuration file on each computer you use. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
224 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
225 A line with ``%unset name`` will remove ``name`` from the current |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
226 section, if it has been set previously. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
227 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
228 The values are either free-form text strings, lists of text strings, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
229 or Boolean values. Boolean values can be set to true using any of "1", |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
230 "yes", "true", or "on" and to false using "0", "no", "false", or "off" |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
231 (all case insensitive). |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
232 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
233 List values are separated by whitespace or comma, except when values are |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
234 placed in double quotation marks:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
235 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
236 allow_read = "John Doe, PhD", brian, betty |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
237 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
238 Quotation marks can be escaped by prefixing them with a backslash. Only |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
239 quotation marks at the beginning of a word is counted as a quotation |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
240 (e.g., ``foo"bar baz`` is the list of ``foo"bar`` and ``baz``). |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
241 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
242 Sections |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
243 ======== |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
244 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
245 This section describes the different sections that may appear in a |
14652
73cb35f6fd78
help/config: do not refer to config files as hgrc files
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14651
diff
changeset
|
246 Mercurial configuration file, the purpose of each section, its possible |
73cb35f6fd78
help/config: do not refer to config files as hgrc files
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14651
diff
changeset
|
247 keys, and their possible values. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
248 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
249 ``alias`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
250 --------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
251 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
252 Defines command aliases. |
26172 | 253 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
254 Aliases allow you to define your own commands in terms of other |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
255 commands (or aliases), optionally including arguments. Positional |
26176
3fb59f43a430
help/config: alias, ui.mergemarkertemplate add period for etc.
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26172
diff
changeset
|
256 arguments in the form of ``$1``, ``$2``, etc. in the alias definition |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
257 are expanded by Mercurial before execution. Positional arguments not |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
258 already used by ``$N`` in the definition are put at the end of the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
259 command to be executed. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
260 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
261 Alias definitions consist of lines of the form:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
262 |
14653
6f96c7a908bd
help/config: fix small typo
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14652
diff
changeset
|
263 <alias> = <command> [<argument>]... |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
264 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
265 For example, this definition:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
266 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
267 latest = log --limit 5 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
268 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
269 creates a new command ``latest`` that shows only the five most recent |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
270 changesets. You can define subsequent aliases using earlier ones:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
271 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
272 stable5 = latest -b stable |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
273 |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
274 .. note:: |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
275 |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
276 It is possible to create aliases with the same names as |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
277 existing commands, which will then override the original |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
278 definitions. This is almost always a bad idea! |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
279 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
280 An alias can start with an exclamation point (``!``) to make it a |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
281 shell alias. A shell alias is executed with the shell and will let you |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
282 run arbitrary commands. As an example, :: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
283 |
16513
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
284 echo = !echo $@ |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
285 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
286 will let you do ``hg echo foo`` to have ``foo`` printed in your |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
287 terminal. A better example might be:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
288 |
31001
e7eca6e1372e
doc: correct example concerning "hg purge" alias in man page "hgrc.5"
Rainer Woitok <Rainer.Woitok@Gmail.Com>
parents:
30941
diff
changeset
|
289 purge = !$HG status --no-status --unknown -0 re: | xargs -0 rm -f |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
290 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
291 which will make ``hg purge`` delete all unknown files in the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
292 repository in the same manner as the purge extension. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
293 |
16513
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
294 Positional arguments like ``$1``, ``$2``, etc. in the alias definition |
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
295 expand to the command arguments. Unmatched arguments are |
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
296 removed. ``$0`` expands to the alias name and ``$@`` expands to all |
22158
bc2132dfc0a4
alias: expand "$@" as list of parameters quoted individually (BC) (issue4200)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
22032
diff
changeset
|
297 arguments separated by a space. ``"$@"`` (with quotes) expands to all |
bc2132dfc0a4
alias: expand "$@" as list of parameters quoted individually (BC) (issue4200)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
22032
diff
changeset
|
298 arguments quoted individually and separated by a space. These expansions |
bc2132dfc0a4
alias: expand "$@" as list of parameters quoted individually (BC) (issue4200)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
22032
diff
changeset
|
299 happen before the command is passed to the shell. |
16513
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
300 |
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
301 Shell aliases are executed in an environment where ``$HG`` expands to |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
302 the path of the Mercurial that was used to execute the alias. This is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
303 useful when you want to call further Mercurial commands in a shell |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
304 alias, as was done above for the purge alias. In addition, |
16513
aa252059a98f
alias: fix shell alias documentation (issue3374)
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16399
diff
changeset
|
305 ``$HG_ARGS`` expands to the arguments given to Mercurial. In the ``hg |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
306 echo foo`` call above, ``$HG_ARGS`` would expand to ``echo foo``. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
307 |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
308 .. note:: |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
309 |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
310 Some global configuration options such as ``-R`` are |
14891
62122c1c830b
alias: note interaction of shell aliases with early opts in help
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
14691
diff
changeset
|
311 processed before shell aliases and will thus not be passed to |
62122c1c830b
alias: note interaction of shell aliases with early opts in help
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
14691
diff
changeset
|
312 aliases. |
62122c1c830b
alias: note interaction of shell aliases with early opts in help
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
14691
diff
changeset
|
313 |
15528
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
314 |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
315 ``annotate`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
316 ------------ |
15528
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
317 |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
318 Settings used when displaying file annotations. All values are |
26280
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
319 Booleans and default to False. See :hg:`help config.diff` for |
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
320 related options for the diff command. |
15528
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
321 |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
322 ``ignorews`` |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
323 Ignore white space when comparing lines. |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
324 |
34013
da07367d683b
mdiff: add a --ignore-space-at-eol option
David Soria Parra <davidsp@fb.com>
parents:
33260
diff
changeset
|
325 ``ignorewseol`` |
da07367d683b
mdiff: add a --ignore-space-at-eol option
David Soria Parra <davidsp@fb.com>
parents:
33260
diff
changeset
|
326 Ignore white space at the end of a line when comparing lines. |
da07367d683b
mdiff: add a --ignore-space-at-eol option
David Soria Parra <davidsp@fb.com>
parents:
33260
diff
changeset
|
327 |
15528
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
328 ``ignorewsamount`` |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
329 Ignore changes in the amount of white space. |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
330 |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
331 ``ignoreblanklines`` |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
332 Ignore changes whose lines are all blank. |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
333 |
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
334 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
335 ``auth`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
336 -------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
337 |
31936
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
338 Authentication credentials and other authentication-like configuration |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
339 for HTTP connections. This section allows you to store usernames and |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
340 passwords for use when logging *into* HTTP servers. See |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
341 :hg:`help config.web` if you want to configure *who* can login to |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
342 your HTTP server. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
343 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
344 The following options apply to all hosts. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
345 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
346 ``cookiefile`` |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
347 Path to a file containing HTTP cookie lines. Cookies matching a |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
348 host will be sent automatically. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
349 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
350 The file format uses the Mozilla cookies.txt format, which defines cookies |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
351 on their own lines. Each line contains 7 fields delimited by the tab |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
352 character (domain, is_domain_cookie, path, is_secure, expires, name, |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
353 value). For more info, do an Internet search for "Netscape cookies.txt |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
354 format." |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
355 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
356 Note: the cookies parser does not handle port numbers on domains. You |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
357 will need to remove ports from the domain for the cookie to be recognized. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
358 This could result in a cookie being disclosed to an unwanted server. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
359 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
360 The cookies file is read-only. |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
361 |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
362 Other options in this section are grouped by name and have the following |
806f9a883b4f
url: support auth.cookiesfile for adding cookies to HTTP requests
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
31747
diff
changeset
|
363 format:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
364 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
365 <name>.<argument> = <value> |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
366 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
367 where ``<name>`` is used to group arguments into authentication |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
368 entries. Example:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
369 |
28191
535f2900d078
help: hg.intevation.de is new primary name of hg.intevation.de (and new cert)
Thomas Arendsen Hein <thomas@intevation.de>
parents:
28057
diff
changeset
|
370 foo.prefix = hg.intevation.de/mercurial |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
371 foo.username = foo |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
372 foo.password = bar |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
373 foo.schemes = http https |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
374 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
375 bar.prefix = secure.example.org |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
376 bar.key = path/to/file.key |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
377 bar.cert = path/to/file.cert |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
378 bar.schemes = https |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
379 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
380 Supported arguments: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
381 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
382 ``prefix`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
383 Either ``*`` or a URI prefix with or without the scheme part. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
384 The authentication entry with the longest matching prefix is used |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
385 (where ``*`` matches everything and counts as a match of length |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
386 1). If the prefix doesn't include a scheme, the match is performed |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
387 against the URI with its scheme stripped as well, and the schemes |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
388 argument, q.v., is then subsequently consulted. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
389 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
390 ``username`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
391 Optional. Username to authenticate with. If not given, and the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
392 remote site requires basic or digest authentication, the user will |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
393 be prompted for it. Environment variables are expanded in the |
15005
4a43e23b8c55
hgweb: do not ignore [auth] if url has a username (issue2822)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15004
diff
changeset
|
394 username letting you do ``foo.username = $USER``. If the URI |
4a43e23b8c55
hgweb: do not ignore [auth] if url has a username (issue2822)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15004
diff
changeset
|
395 includes a username, only ``[auth]`` entries with a matching |
4a43e23b8c55
hgweb: do not ignore [auth] if url has a username (issue2822)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15004
diff
changeset
|
396 username or without a username will be considered. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
397 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
398 ``password`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
399 Optional. Password to authenticate with. If not given, and the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
400 remote site requires basic or digest authentication, the user |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
401 will be prompted for it. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
402 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
403 ``key`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
404 Optional. PEM encoded client certificate key file. Environment |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
405 variables are expanded in the filename. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
406 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
407 ``cert`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
408 Optional. PEM encoded client certificate chain file. Environment |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
409 variables are expanded in the filename. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
410 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
411 ``schemes`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
412 Optional. Space separated list of URI schemes to use this |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
413 authentication entry with. Only used if the prefix doesn't include |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
414 a scheme. Supported schemes are http and https. They will match |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
415 static-http and static-https respectively, as well. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
416 (default: https) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
417 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
418 If no suitable authentication entry is found, the user is prompted |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
419 for credentials as usual if required by the remote. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
420 |
45057
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
421 ``cmdserver`` |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
422 ------------- |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
423 |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
424 Controls command server settings. (ADVANCED) |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
425 |
45058
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
426 ``message-encodings`` |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
427 List of encodings for the ``m`` (message) channel. The first encoding |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
428 supported by the server will be selected and advertised in the hello |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
429 message. This is useful only when ``ui.message-output`` is set to |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
430 ``channel``. Supported encodings are ``cbor``. |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
431 |
45057
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
432 ``shutdown-on-interrupt`` |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
433 If set to false, the server's main loop will continue running after |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
434 SIGINT received. ``runcommand`` requests can still be interrupted by |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
435 SIGINT. Close the write end of the pipe to shut down the server |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
436 process gracefully. |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
437 (default: True) |
d6e99a446eea
cmdserver: add option to not exit from message loop on SIGINT
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
44412
diff
changeset
|
438 |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
439 ``color`` |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
440 --------- |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
441 |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
442 Configure the Mercurial color mode. For details about how to define your custom |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
443 effect and style see :hg:`help color`. |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
444 |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
445 ``mode`` |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
446 String: control the method used to output color. One of ``auto``, ``ansi``, |
32081
a6865b35a10d
help: use mercurial as a subject of colorization and pagination
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32033
diff
changeset
|
447 ``win32``, ``terminfo`` or ``debug``. In auto mode, Mercurial will |
32666
dd0bdeb0feee
help: update the color documentation for Windows 10 ANSI support
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32274
diff
changeset
|
448 use ANSI mode by default (or win32 mode prior to Windows 10) if it detects a |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
449 terminal. Any invalid value will disable color. |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
450 |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
451 ``pagermode`` |
32139
de86a6872d06
help: spelling fixes
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32104
diff
changeset
|
452 String: optional override of ``color.mode`` used with pager. |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
453 |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
454 On some systems, terminfo mode may cause problems when using |
32081
a6865b35a10d
help: use mercurial as a subject of colorization and pagination
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32033
diff
changeset
|
455 color with ``less -R`` as a pager program. less with the -R option |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
456 will only display ECMA-48 color codes, and terminfo mode may sometimes |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
457 emit codes that less doesn't understand. You can work around this by |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
458 either using ansi mode (or auto mode), or by using less -r (which will |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
459 pass through all terminal control codes, not just color control |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
460 codes). |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
461 |
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
462 On some systems (such as MSYS in Windows), the terminal may support |
32081
a6865b35a10d
help: use mercurial as a subject of colorization and pagination
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32033
diff
changeset
|
463 a different color mode than the pager program. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
464 |
31557
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
465 ``commands`` |
31591
2c02bb7fd7fc
help: format ``commands`` heading correctly
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
31589
diff
changeset
|
466 ------------ |
31557
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
467 |
42244
0f01394457a0
commit: add ability to print file status after each successful invocation
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
42139
diff
changeset
|
468 ``commit.post-status`` |
0f01394457a0
commit: add ability to print file status after each successful invocation
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
42139
diff
changeset
|
469 Show status of files in the working directory after successful commit. |
0f01394457a0
commit: add ability to print file status after each successful invocation
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
42139
diff
changeset
|
470 (default: False) |
0f01394457a0
commit: add ability to print file status after each successful invocation
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
42139
diff
changeset
|
471 |
43873
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
472 ``merge.require-rev`` |
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
473 Require that the revision to merge the current commit with be specified on |
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
474 the command line. If this is enabled and a revision is not specified, the |
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
475 command aborts. |
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
476 (default: False) |
8caec25f5d8f
merge: add commands.merge.require-rev to require an argument to hg merge
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
43669
diff
changeset
|
477 |
43163
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
478 ``push.require-revs`` |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
479 Require revisions to push be specified using one or more mechanisms such as |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
480 specifying them positionally on the command line, using ``-r``, ``-b``, |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
481 and/or ``-B`` on the command line, or using ``paths.<path>:pushrev`` in the |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
482 configuration. If this is enabled and revisions are not specified, the |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
483 command aborts. |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
484 (default: False) |
5617b748aad8
push: support config option to require revs be specified when running push
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
42932
diff
changeset
|
485 |
38822
f8732e33bcbc
resolve: add confirm config option
Sushil khanchi <sushilkhanchi97@gmail.com>
parents:
38754
diff
changeset
|
486 ``resolve.confirm`` |
38875
755741c39230
resolve: update commands.resolve.confirm help text
Sushil khanchi <sushilkhanchi97@gmail.com>
parents:
38857
diff
changeset
|
487 Confirm before performing action if no filename is passed. |
38822
f8732e33bcbc
resolve: add confirm config option
Sushil khanchi <sushilkhanchi97@gmail.com>
parents:
38754
diff
changeset
|
488 (default: False) |
f8732e33bcbc
resolve: add confirm config option
Sushil khanchi <sushilkhanchi97@gmail.com>
parents:
38754
diff
changeset
|
489 |
39393
56469d475341
resolve: add config to make hg resolve not re-merge by default
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
39125
diff
changeset
|
490 ``resolve.explicit-re-merge`` |
56469d475341
resolve: add config to make hg resolve not re-merge by default
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
39125
diff
changeset
|
491 Require uses of ``hg resolve`` to specify which action it should perform, |
56469d475341
resolve: add config to make hg resolve not re-merge by default
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
39125
diff
changeset
|
492 instead of re-merging files by default. |
56469d475341
resolve: add config to make hg resolve not re-merge by default
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
39125
diff
changeset
|
493 (default: False) |
56469d475341
resolve: add config to make hg resolve not re-merge by default
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
39125
diff
changeset
|
494 |
38857
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
495 ``resolve.mark-check`` |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
496 Determines what level of checking :hg:`resolve --mark` will perform before |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
497 marking files as resolved. Valid values are ``none`, ``warn``, and |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
498 ``abort``. ``warn`` will output a warning listing the file(s) that still |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
499 have conflict markers in them, but will still mark everything resolved. |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
500 ``abort`` will output the same warning but will not mark things as resolved. |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
501 If --all is passed and this is set to ``abort``, only a warning will be |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
502 shown (an error will not be raised). |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
503 (default: ``none``) |
96d0795bd0bd
resolve: graduate resolve.mark-check from experimental, add docs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
38822
diff
changeset
|
504 |
31589
7e3b145f8247
status: support commands.status.relative config
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
31557
diff
changeset
|
505 ``status.relative`` |
32082
202b86a509e0
help: use hg role of mini reST to make hyper link in HTML page
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32081
diff
changeset
|
506 Make paths in :hg:`status` output relative to the current directory. |
31589
7e3b145f8247
status: support commands.status.relative config
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
31557
diff
changeset
|
507 (default: False) |
7e3b145f8247
status: support commands.status.relative config
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
31557
diff
changeset
|
508 |
38100
18424aeece7f
status: add a config knob for setting default of --terse
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
37498
diff
changeset
|
509 ``status.terse`` |
41106 | 510 Default value for the --terse flag, which condenses status output. |
38100
18424aeece7f
status: add a config knob for setting default of --terse
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
37498
diff
changeset
|
511 (default: empty) |
18424aeece7f
status: add a config knob for setting default of --terse
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
37498
diff
changeset
|
512 |
34705
23ed47a895d5
config: graduate experimental.updatecheck to commands.update.check
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
34314
diff
changeset
|
513 ``update.check`` |
23ed47a895d5
config: graduate experimental.updatecheck to commands.update.check
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
34314
diff
changeset
|
514 Determines what level of checking :hg:`update` will perform before moving |
23ed47a895d5
config: graduate experimental.updatecheck to commands.update.check
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
34314
diff
changeset
|
515 to a destination revision. Valid values are ``abort``, ``none``, |
48408
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
516 ``linear``, and ``noconflict``. |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
517 |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
518 - ``abort`` always fails if the working directory has uncommitted changes. |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
519 |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
520 - ``none`` performs no checking, and may result in a merge with uncommitted changes. |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
521 |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
522 - ``linear`` allows any update as long as it follows a straight line in the |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
523 revision history, and may trigger a merge with uncommitted changes. |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
524 |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
525 - ``noconflict`` will allow any update which would not trigger a merge with |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
526 uncommitted changes, if any are present. |
f77e4daaf612
update: reformat the `commands.update.check` help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48362
diff
changeset
|
527 |
34705
23ed47a895d5
config: graduate experimental.updatecheck to commands.update.check
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
34314
diff
changeset
|
528 (default: ``linear``) |
23ed47a895d5
config: graduate experimental.updatecheck to commands.update.check
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
34314
diff
changeset
|
529 |
31557
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
530 ``update.requiredest`` |
32082
202b86a509e0
help: use hg role of mini reST to make hyper link in HTML page
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32081
diff
changeset
|
531 Require that the user pass a destination when running :hg:`update`. |
202b86a509e0
help: use hg role of mini reST to make hyper link in HTML page
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
32081
diff
changeset
|
532 For example, :hg:`update .::` will be allowed, but a plain :hg:`update` |
31557
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
533 will be disallowed. |
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
534 (default: False) |
79d98e1b21a7
update: add flag to require update destination
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
31125
diff
changeset
|
535 |
21924
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
536 ``committemplate`` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
537 ------------------ |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
538 |
26169
ea888285311f
help: config indent committemplate.changeset section
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26072
diff
changeset
|
539 ``changeset`` |
ea888285311f
help: config indent committemplate.changeset section
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26072
diff
changeset
|
540 String: configuration in this section is used as the template to |
ea888285311f
help: config indent committemplate.changeset section
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26072
diff
changeset
|
541 customize the text shown in the editor when committing. |
21924
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
542 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
543 In addition to pre-defined template keywords, commit log specific one |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
544 below can be used for customization: |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
545 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
546 ``extramsg`` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
547 String: Extra message (typically 'Leave message empty to abort |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
548 commit.'). This may be changed by some commands or extensions. |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
549 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
550 For example, the template configuration below shows as same text as |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
551 one shown by default:: |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
552 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
553 [committemplate] |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
554 changeset = {desc}\n\n |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
555 HG: Enter commit message. Lines beginning with 'HG:' are removed. |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
556 HG: {extramsg} |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
557 HG: -- |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
558 HG: user: {author}\n{ifeq(p2rev, "-1", "", |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
559 "HG: branch merge\n") |
25014
7e5d5160073b
templatekw: replace currentbookmark with activebookmark keyword
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
24830
diff
changeset
|
560 }HG: branch '{branch}'\n{if(activebookmark, |
7e5d5160073b
templatekw: replace currentbookmark with activebookmark keyword
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
24830
diff
changeset
|
561 "HG: bookmark '{activebookmark}'\n") }{subrepos % |
21924
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
562 "HG: subrepo {subrepo}\n" }{file_adds % |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
563 "HG: added {file}\n" }{file_mods % |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
564 "HG: changed {file}\n" }{file_dels % |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
565 "HG: removed {file}\n" }{if(files, "", |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
566 "HG: no files changed\n")} |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
567 |
30704
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
568 ``diff()`` |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
569 String: show the diff (see :hg:`help templates` for detail) |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
570 |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
571 Sometimes it is helpful to show the diff of the changeset in the editor without |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
572 having to prefix 'HG: ' to each line so that highlighting works correctly. For |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
573 this, Mercurial provides a special string which will ignore everything below |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
574 it:: |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
575 |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
576 HG: ------------------------ >8 ------------------------ |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
577 |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
578 For example, the template configuration below will show the diff below the |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
579 extra message:: |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
580 |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
581 [committemplate] |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
582 changeset = {desc}\n\n |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
583 HG: Enter commit message. Lines beginning with 'HG:' are removed. |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
584 HG: {extramsg} |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
585 HG: ------------------------ >8 ------------------------ |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
586 HG: Do not touch the line above. |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
587 HG: Everything below will be removed. |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
588 {diff()} |
0499da0d5a06
config: add docs for ignoring all text below in the editor
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
30347
diff
changeset
|
589 |
21924
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
590 .. note:: |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
591 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
592 For some problematic encodings (see :hg:`help win32mbcs` for |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
593 detail), this customization should be configured carefully, to |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
594 avoid showing broken characters. |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
595 |
26281
5cac3bdb3c67
help/config: reword committemplate multibyte character text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
596 For example, if a multibyte character ending with backslash (0x5c) is |
5cac3bdb3c67
help/config: reword committemplate multibyte character text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
597 followed by the ASCII character 'n' in the customized template, |
5cac3bdb3c67
help/config: reword committemplate multibyte character text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
598 the sequence of backslash and 'n' is treated as line-feed unexpectedly |
5cac3bdb3c67
help/config: reword committemplate multibyte character text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
599 (and the multibyte character is broken, too). |
21924
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
600 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
601 Customized template is used for commands below (``--edit`` may be |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
602 required): |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
603 |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
604 - :hg:`backout` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
605 - :hg:`commit` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
606 - :hg:`fetch` (for merge commit only) |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
607 - :hg:`graft` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
608 - :hg:`histedit` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
609 - :hg:`import` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
610 - :hg:`qfold`, :hg:`qnew` and :hg:`qrefresh` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
611 - :hg:`rebase` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
612 - :hg:`shelve` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
613 - :hg:`sign` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
614 - :hg:`tag` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
615 - :hg:`transplant` |
5375ba75df40
cmdutil: make commit message shown in text editor customizable by template
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21918
diff
changeset
|
616 |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
617 Configuring items below instead of ``changeset`` allows showing |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
618 customized message only for specific actions, or showing different |
23075
2b3189ec3d14
help/config: fix typo
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
22607
diff
changeset
|
619 messages for each action. |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
620 |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
621 - ``changeset.backout`` for :hg:`backout` |
22249
f5ff18f65b73
commit: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from other (--amend)
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22248
diff
changeset
|
622 - ``changeset.commit.amend.merge`` for :hg:`commit --amend` on merges |
f5ff18f65b73
commit: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from other (--amend)
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22248
diff
changeset
|
623 - ``changeset.commit.amend.normal`` for :hg:`commit --amend` on other |
22248
75618a223e18
commit: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22205
diff
changeset
|
624 - ``changeset.commit.normal.merge`` for :hg:`commit` on merges |
75618a223e18
commit: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22205
diff
changeset
|
625 - ``changeset.commit.normal.normal`` for :hg:`commit` on other |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
626 - ``changeset.fetch`` for :hg:`fetch` (impling merge commit) |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
627 - ``changeset.gpg.sign`` for :hg:`sign` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
628 - ``changeset.graft`` for :hg:`graft` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
629 - ``changeset.histedit.edit`` for ``edit`` of :hg:`histedit` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
630 - ``changeset.histedit.fold`` for ``fold`` of :hg:`histedit` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
631 - ``changeset.histedit.mess`` for ``mess`` of :hg:`histedit` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
632 - ``changeset.histedit.pick`` for ``pick`` of :hg:`histedit` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
633 - ``changeset.import.bypass`` for :hg:`import --bypass` |
22250
f3200bf460a8
import: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22249
diff
changeset
|
634 - ``changeset.import.normal.merge`` for :hg:`import` on merges |
f3200bf460a8
import: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22249
diff
changeset
|
635 - ``changeset.import.normal.normal`` for :hg:`import` on other |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
636 - ``changeset.mq.qnew`` for :hg:`qnew` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
637 - ``changeset.mq.qfold`` for :hg:`qfold` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
638 - ``changeset.mq.qrefresh`` for :hg:`qrefresh` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
639 - ``changeset.rebase.collapse`` for :hg:`rebase --collapse` |
22251
d0d3e5c6eb3c
rebase: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22250
diff
changeset
|
640 - ``changeset.rebase.merge`` for :hg:`rebase` on merges |
d0d3e5c6eb3c
rebase: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22250
diff
changeset
|
641 - ``changeset.rebase.normal`` for :hg:`rebase` on other |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
642 - ``changeset.shelve.shelve`` for :hg:`shelve` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
643 - ``changeset.tag.add`` for :hg:`tag` without ``--remove`` |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
644 - ``changeset.tag.remove`` for :hg:`tag --remove` |
22252
de783f2403c4
transplant: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22251
diff
changeset
|
645 - ``changeset.transplant.merge`` for :hg:`transplant` on merges |
de783f2403c4
transplant: change "editform" to distinguish merge commits from others
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22251
diff
changeset
|
646 - ``changeset.transplant.normal`` for :hg:`transplant` on other |
22012
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
647 |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
648 These dot-separated lists of names are treated as hierarchical ones. |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
649 For example, ``changeset.tag.remove`` customizes the commit message |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
650 only for :hg:`tag --remove`, but ``changeset.tag`` customizes the |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
651 commit message for :hg:`tag` regardless of ``--remove`` option. |
9d92b9d1e282
cmdutil: look commit template definition up by specified 'editform'
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
652 |
26282
436f5ab16079
help/config: reword committemplate external editor text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26281
diff
changeset
|
653 When the external editor is invoked for a commit, the corresponding |
436f5ab16079
help/config: reword committemplate external editor text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26281
diff
changeset
|
654 dot-separated list of names without the ``changeset.`` prefix |
436f5ab16079
help/config: reword committemplate external editor text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26281
diff
changeset
|
655 (e.g. ``commit.normal.normal``) is in the ``HGEDITFORM`` environment |
436f5ab16079
help/config: reword committemplate external editor text
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26281
diff
changeset
|
656 variable. |
22205
9fa429723f26
ui: invoke editor for committing with HGEDITFORM environment variable
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22158
diff
changeset
|
657 |
22013
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
658 In this section, items other than ``changeset`` can be referred from |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
659 others. For example, the configuration to list committed files up |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
660 below can be referred as ``{listupfiles}``:: |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
661 |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
662 [committemplate] |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
663 listupfiles = {file_adds % |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
664 "HG: added {file}\n" }{file_mods % |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
665 "HG: changed {file}\n" }{file_dels % |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
666 "HG: removed {file}\n" }{if(files, "", |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
667 "HG: no files changed\n")} |
de5cee8ba088
cmdutil: use '[committemplate]' section like as map file for style definition
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
22012
diff
changeset
|
668 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
669 ``decode/encode`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
670 ----------------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
671 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
672 Filters for transforming files on checkout/checkin. This would |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
673 typically be used for newline processing or other |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
674 localization/canonicalization of files. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
675 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
676 Filters consist of a filter pattern followed by a filter command. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
677 Filter patterns are globs by default, rooted at the repository root. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
678 For example, to match any file ending in ``.txt`` in the root |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
679 directory only, use the pattern ``*.txt``. To match any file ending |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
680 in ``.c`` anywhere in the repository, use the pattern ``**.c``. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
681 For each file only the first matching filter applies. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
682 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
683 The filter command can start with a specifier, either ``pipe:`` or |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
684 ``tempfile:``. If no specifier is given, ``pipe:`` is used by default. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
685 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
686 A ``pipe:`` command must accept data on stdin and return the transformed |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
687 data on stdout. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
688 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
689 Pipe example:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
690 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
691 [encode] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
692 # uncompress gzip files on checkin to improve delta compression |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
693 # note: not necessarily a good idea, just an example |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
694 *.gz = pipe: gunzip |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
695 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
696 [decode] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
697 # recompress gzip files when writing them to the working dir (we |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
698 # can safely omit "pipe:", because it's the default) |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
699 *.gz = gzip |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
700 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
701 A ``tempfile:`` command is a template. The string ``INFILE`` is replaced |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
702 with the name of a temporary file that contains the data to be |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
703 filtered by the command. The string ``OUTFILE`` is replaced with the name |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
704 of an empty temporary file, where the filtered data must be written by |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
705 the command. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
706 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
707 .. container:: windows |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
708 |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
709 .. note:: |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
710 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
711 The tempfile mechanism is recommended for Windows systems, |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
712 where the standard shell I/O redirection operators often have |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
713 strange effects and may corrupt the contents of your files. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
714 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
715 This filter mechanism is used internally by the ``eol`` extension to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
716 translate line ending characters between Windows (CRLF) and Unix (LF) |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
717 format. We suggest you use the ``eol`` extension for convenience. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
718 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
719 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
720 ``defaults`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
721 ------------ |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
722 |
26177 | 723 (defaults are deprecated. Don't use them. Use aliases instead.) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
724 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
725 Use the ``[defaults]`` section to define command defaults, i.e. the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
726 default options/arguments to pass to the specified commands. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
727 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
728 The following example makes :hg:`log` run in verbose mode, and |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
729 :hg:`status` show only the modified files, by default:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
730 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
731 [defaults] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
732 log = -v |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
733 status = -m |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
734 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
735 The actual commands, instead of their aliases, must be used when |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
736 defining command defaults. The command defaults will also be applied |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
737 to the aliases of the commands defined. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
738 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
739 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
740 ``diff`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
741 -------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
742 |
15528
a84698badf0b
annotate: support diff whitespace filtering flags (issue3030)
Patrick Mezard <pmezard@gmail.com>
parents:
15321
diff
changeset
|
743 Settings used when displaying diffs. Everything except for ``unified`` |
26280
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
744 is a Boolean and defaults to False. See :hg:`help config.annotate` |
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
745 for related options for the annotate command. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
746 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
747 ``git`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
748 Use git extended diff format. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
749 |
22602
551d776a0a9a
diff: document the nobinary option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
750 ``nobinary`` |
551d776a0a9a
diff: document the nobinary option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
751 Omit git binary patches. |
551d776a0a9a
diff: document the nobinary option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
21924
diff
changeset
|
752 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
753 ``nodates`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
754 Don't include dates in diff headers. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
755 |
23297
d7abae94a7a0
patch.diffopts: add support for noprefix
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23142
diff
changeset
|
756 ``noprefix`` |
d7abae94a7a0
patch.diffopts: add support for noprefix
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23142
diff
changeset
|
757 Omit 'a/' and 'b/' prefixes from filenames. Ignored in plain mode. |
d7abae94a7a0
patch.diffopts: add support for noprefix
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23142
diff
changeset
|
758 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
759 ``showfunc`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
760 Show which function each change is in. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
761 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
762 ``ignorews`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
763 Ignore white space when comparing lines. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
764 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
765 ``ignorewsamount`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
766 Ignore changes in the amount of white space. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
767 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
768 ``ignoreblanklines`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
769 Ignore changes whose lines are all blank. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
770 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
771 ``unified`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
772 Number of lines of context to show. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
773 |
38591
be441eb65f09
diff: graduate word-diff option from experimental
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
38484
diff
changeset
|
774 ``word-diff`` |
be441eb65f09
diff: graduate word-diff option from experimental
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
38484
diff
changeset
|
775 Highlight changed words. |
be441eb65f09
diff: graduate word-diff option from experimental
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
38484
diff
changeset
|
776 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
777 ``email`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
778 --------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
779 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
780 Settings for extensions that send email messages. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
781 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
782 ``from`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
783 Optional. Email address to use in "From" header and SMTP envelope |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
784 of outgoing messages. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
785 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
786 ``to`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
787 Optional. Comma-separated list of recipients' email addresses. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
788 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
789 ``cc`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
790 Optional. Comma-separated list of carbon copy recipients' |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
791 email addresses. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
792 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
793 ``bcc`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
794 Optional. Comma-separated list of blind carbon copy recipients' |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
795 email addresses. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
796 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
797 ``method`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
798 Optional. Method to use to send email messages. If value is ``smtp`` |
14654
e21fd445c297
help/config: quote config section names consistently
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14653
diff
changeset
|
799 (default), use SMTP (see the ``[smtp]`` section for configuration). |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
800 Otherwise, use as name of program to run that acts like sendmail |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
801 (takes ``-f`` option for sender, list of recipients on command line, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
802 message on stdin). Normally, setting this to ``sendmail`` or |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
803 ``/usr/sbin/sendmail`` is enough to use sendmail to send messages. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
804 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
805 ``charsets`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
806 Optional. Comma-separated list of character sets considered |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
807 convenient for recipients. Addresses, headers, and parts not |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
808 containing patches of outgoing messages will be encoded in the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
809 first character set to which conversion from local encoding |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
810 (``$HGENCODING``, ``ui.fallbackencoding``) succeeds. If correct |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
811 conversion fails, the text in question is sent as is. |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
812 (default: '') |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
813 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
814 Order of outgoing email character sets: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
815 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
816 1. ``us-ascii``: always first, regardless of settings |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
817 2. ``email.charsets``: in order given by user |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
818 3. ``ui.fallbackencoding``: if not in email.charsets |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
819 4. ``$HGENCODING``: if not in email.charsets |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
820 5. ``utf-8``: always last, regardless of settings |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
821 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
822 Email example:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
823 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
824 [email] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
825 from = Joseph User <joe.user@example.com> |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
826 method = /usr/sbin/sendmail |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
827 # charsets for western Europeans |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
828 # us-ascii, utf-8 omitted, as they are tried first and last |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
829 charsets = iso-8859-1, iso-8859-15, windows-1252 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
830 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
831 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
832 ``extensions`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
833 -------------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
834 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
835 Mercurial has an extension mechanism for adding new features. To |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
836 enable an extension, create an entry for it in this section. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
837 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
838 If you know that the extension is already in Python's search path, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
839 you can give the name of the module, followed by ``=``, with nothing |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
840 after the ``=``. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
841 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
842 Otherwise, give a name that you choose, followed by ``=``, followed by |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
843 the path to the ``.py`` file (including the file name extension) that |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
844 defines the extension. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
845 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
846 To explicitly disable an extension that is enabled in an hgrc of |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
847 broader scope, prepend its path with ``!``, as in ``foo = !/ext/path`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
848 or ``foo = !`` when path is not supplied. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
849 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
850 Example for ``~/.hgrc``:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
851 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
852 [extensions] |
31125
01a0ea04c372
help: use 'churn' instead of 'color' as an example extension
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31123
diff
changeset
|
853 # (the churn extension will get loaded from Mercurial's path) |
01a0ea04c372
help: use 'churn' instead of 'color' as an example extension
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31123
diff
changeset
|
854 churn = |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
855 # (this extension will get loaded from the file specified) |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
856 myfeature = ~/.hgext/myfeature.py |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
857 |
48361
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
858 If an extension fails to load, a warning will be issued, and Mercurial will |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
859 proceed. To enforce that an extension must be loaded, one can set the `required` |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
860 suboption in the config:: |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
861 |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
862 [extensions] |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
863 myfeature = ~/.hgext/myfeature.py |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
864 myfeature:required = yes |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
865 |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
866 To debug extension loading issue, one can add `--traceback` to their mercurial |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
867 invocation. |
0d0ce2529540
extension: add a `required` suboption to enforce the use of an extensions
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
868 |
48362
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
869 A default setting can we set using the special `*` extension key:: |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
870 |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
871 [extensions] |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
872 *:required = yes |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
873 myfeature = ~/.hgext/myfeature.py |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
874 rebase= |
7e6488aa1261
extensions: add a default "*" suboptions prefix
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48361
diff
changeset
|
875 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
876 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
877 ``format`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
878 ---------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
879 |
38735
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
880 Configuration that controls the repository format. Newer format options are more |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
881 powerful, but incompatible with some older versions of Mercurial. Format options |
38735
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
882 are considered at repository initialization only. You need to make a new clone |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
883 for config changes to be taken into account. |
38735
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
884 |
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
885 For more details about repository format and version compatibility, see |
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
886 https://www.mercurial-scm.org/wiki/MissingRequirement |
8891dc15b327
config: document the purpose of the `format` config section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38725
diff
changeset
|
887 |
26907
dfab6edb98e3
format: introduce 'format.usegeneraldelta`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
26730
diff
changeset
|
888 ``usegeneraldelta`` |
dfab6edb98e3
format: introduce 'format.usegeneraldelta`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
26730
diff
changeset
|
889 Enable or disable the "generaldelta" repository format which improves |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
890 repository compression by allowing "revlog" to store deltas against |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
891 arbitrary revisions instead of the previously stored one. This provides |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
892 significant improvement for repositories with branches. |
27606
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
893 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
894 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 1.9. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
895 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
896 Enabled by default. |
26907
dfab6edb98e3
format: introduce 'format.usegeneraldelta`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
26730
diff
changeset
|
897 |
27605
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
898 ``dotencode`` |
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
899 Enable or disable the "dotencode" repository format which enhances |
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
900 the "fncache" repository format (which has to be enabled to use |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
901 dotencode) to avoid issues with filenames starting with "._" on |
27606
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
902 Mac OS X and spaces on Windows. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
903 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
904 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 1.7. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
905 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
906 Enabled by default. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
907 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
908 ``usefncache`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
909 Enable or disable the "fncache" repository format which enhances |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
910 the "store" repository format (which has to be enabled to use |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
911 fncache) to allow longer filenames and avoids using Windows |
27606
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
912 reserved names, e.g. "nul". |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
913 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
914 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 1.1. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
915 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
916 Enabled by default. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
917 |
48674
f7086f6173f8
dirstate-v2: rename the configuration to enable the format
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48534
diff
changeset
|
918 ``use-dirstate-v2`` |
48533
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
919 Enable or disable the experimental "dirstate-v2" feature. The dirstate |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
920 functionality is shared by all commands interacting with the working copy. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
921 The new version is more robust, faster and stores more information. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
922 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
923 The performance-improving version of this feature is currently only |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
924 implemented in Rust (see :hg:`help rust`), so people not using a version of |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
925 Mercurial compiled with the Rust parts might actually suffer some slowdown. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
926 For this reason, such versions will by default refuse to access repositories |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
927 with "dirstate-v2" enabled. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
928 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
929 This behavior can be adjusted via configuration: check |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
930 :hg:`help config.storage.dirstate-v2.slow-path` for details. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
931 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
932 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial 6.0 or above. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
933 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
934 By default this format variant is disabled if the fast implementation is not |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
935 available, and enabled by default if the fast implementation is available. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
936 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
937 To accomodate installations of Mercurial without the fast implementation, |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
938 you can downgrade your repository. To do so run the following command: |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
939 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
940 $ hg debugupgraderepo \ |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
941 --run \ |
48674
f7086f6173f8
dirstate-v2: rename the configuration to enable the format
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48534
diff
changeset
|
942 --config format.use-dirstate-v2=False \ |
48533
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
943 --config storage.dirstate-v2.slow-path=allow |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
944 |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
945 For a more comprehensive guide, see :hg:`help internals.dirstate-v2`. |
5e7a0348acf8
docs: add missing dirstate-v2 documentation
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48244
diff
changeset
|
946 |
49195
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
947 ``use-dirstate-v2.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories`` |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
948 When enabled, an automatic upgrade will be triggered when a repository format |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
949 does not match its `use-dirstate-v2` config. |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
950 |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
951 This is an advanced behavior that most users will not need. We recommend you |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
952 don't use this unless you are a seasoned administrator of a Mercurial install |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
953 base. |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
954 |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
955 Automatic upgrade means that any process accessing the repository will |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
956 upgrade the repository format to use `dirstate-v2`. This only triggers if a |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
957 change is needed. This also applies to operations that would have been |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
958 read-only (like hg status). |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
959 |
49200
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
960 If the repository cannot be locked, the automatic-upgrade operation will be |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
961 skipped. The next operation will attempt it again. |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
962 |
49195
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
963 This configuration will apply for moves in any direction, either adding the |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
964 `dirstate-v2` format if `format.use-dirstate-v2=yes` or removing the |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
965 `dirstate-v2` requirement if `format.use-dirstate-v2=no`. So we recommend |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
966 setting both this value and `format.use-dirstate-v2` at the same time. |
411d591e0a27
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from dirstate-v2
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49194
diff
changeset
|
967 |
49341
b38f5063a0c6
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the dirstate-v2 message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49339
diff
changeset
|
968 ``use-dirstate-v2.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories:quiet`` |
b38f5063a0c6
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the dirstate-v2 message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49339
diff
changeset
|
969 Hide message when performing such automatic upgrade. |
b38f5063a0c6
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the dirstate-v2 message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49339
diff
changeset
|
970 |
48793
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
971 ``use-dirstate-tracked-hint`` |
48684
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
972 Enable or disable the writing of "tracked key" file alongside the dirstate. |
48771
79a967128055
dirstate-tracked-key: update the config value to match latest discussion
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48728
diff
changeset
|
973 (default to disabled) |
48684
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
974 |
48793
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
975 That "tracked-hint" can help external automations to detect changes to the |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
976 set of tracked files. (i.e the result of `hg files` or `hg status -macd`) |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
977 |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
978 The tracked-hint is written in a new `.hg/dirstate-tracked-hint`. That file |
48684
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
979 contains two lines: |
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
980 - the first line is the file version (currently: 1), |
48793
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
981 - the second line contains the "tracked-hint". |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
982 That file is written right after the dirstate is written. |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
983 |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
984 The tracked-hint changes whenever the set of file tracked in the dirstate |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
985 changes. The general idea is: |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
986 - if the hint is identical, the set of tracked file SHOULD be identical, |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
987 - if the hint is different, the set of tracked file MIGHT be different. |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
988 |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
989 The "hint is identical" case uses `SHOULD` as the dirstate and the hint file |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
990 are two distinct files and therefore that cannot be read or written to in an |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
991 atomic way. If the key is identical, nothing garantees that the dirstate is |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
992 not updated right after the hint file. This is considered a negligible |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
993 limitation for the intended usecase. It is actually possible to prevent this |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
994 race by taking the repository lock during read operations. |
48684
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
995 |
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
996 They are two "ways" to use this feature: |
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
997 |
48793
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
998 1) monitoring changes to the `.hg/dirstate-tracked-hint`, if the file |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
999 changes, the tracked set might have changed. |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
1000 |
6e559391f96e
tracked-key: remove the dual write and rename to tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48792
diff
changeset
|
1001 2) storing the value and comparing it to a later value. |
48684
568f63b5a30f
dirstate: introduce a "tracked-key" feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48681
diff
changeset
|
1002 |
49194
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1003 |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1004 ``use-dirstate-tracked-hint.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories`` |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1005 When enabled, an automatic upgrade will be triggered when a repository format |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1006 does not match its `use-dirstate-tracked-hint` config. |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1007 |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1008 This is an advanced behavior that most users will not need. We recommend you |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1009 don't use this unless you are a seasoned administrator of a Mercurial install |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1010 base. |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1011 |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1012 Automatic upgrade means that any process accessing the repository will |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1013 upgrade the repository format to use `dirstate-tracked-hint`. This only |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1014 triggers if a change is needed. This also applies to operations that would |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1015 have been read-only (like hg status). |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1016 |
49200
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1017 If the repository cannot be locked, the automatic-upgrade operation will be |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1018 skipped. The next operation will attempt it again. |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1019 |
49194
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1020 This configuration will apply for moves in any direction, either adding the |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1021 `dirstate-tracked-hint` format if `format.use-dirstate-tracked-hint=yes` or |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1022 removing the `dirstate-tracked-hint` requirement if |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1023 `format.use-dirstate-tracked-hint=no`. So we recommend setting both this |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1024 value and `format.use-dirstate-tracked-hint` at the same time. |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1025 |
e4b31016e194
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from tracked-hint
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49192
diff
changeset
|
1026 |
49342
67b210bb5ce2
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the tracked-hint message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49341
diff
changeset
|
1027 ``use-dirstate-tracked-hint.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories:quiet`` |
67b210bb5ce2
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the tracked-hint message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49341
diff
changeset
|
1028 Hide message when performing such automatic upgrade. |
67b210bb5ce2
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the tracked-hint message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49341
diff
changeset
|
1029 |
67b210bb5ce2
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the tracked-hint message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49341
diff
changeset
|
1030 |
46305
8b94f05ab069
persistent-nodemap: document the feature in `hg help config.format`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46139
diff
changeset
|
1031 ``use-persistent-nodemap`` |
8b94f05ab069
persistent-nodemap: document the feature in `hg help config.format`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46139
diff
changeset
|
1032 Enable or disable the "persistent-nodemap" feature which improves |
48534
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1033 performance if the Rust extensions are available. |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1034 |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1035 The "persistent-nodemap" persist the "node -> rev" on disk removing the |
46305
8b94f05ab069
persistent-nodemap: document the feature in `hg help config.format`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46139
diff
changeset
|
1036 need to dynamically build that mapping for each Mercurial invocation. This |
48534
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1037 significantly reduces the startup cost of various local and server-side |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1038 operation for larger repositories. |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1039 |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1040 The performance-improving version of this feature is currently only |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1041 implemented in Rust (see :hg:`help rust`), so people not using a version of |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1042 Mercurial compiled with the Rust parts might actually suffer some slowdown. |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1043 For this reason, such versions will by default refuse to access repositories |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1044 with "persistent-nodemap". |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1045 |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1046 This behavior can be adjusted via configuration: check |
47768
c2b8ad34d245
help: use the correct spelling for `slow-path` in persistent nodemap help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47274
diff
changeset
|
1047 :hg:`help config.storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.slow-path` for details. |
46305
8b94f05ab069
persistent-nodemap: document the feature in `hg help config.format`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46139
diff
changeset
|
1048 |
48534
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1049 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial 5.4 or above. |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1050 |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1051 By default this format variant is disabled if the fast implementation is not |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1052 available, and enabled by default if the fast implementation is available. |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1053 |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1054 To accomodate installations of Mercurial without the fast implementation, |
7e7eaef091c6
docs: fix typos and wording for the persistent-nodemap feature
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
48533
diff
changeset
|
1055 you can downgrade your repository. To do so run the following command: |
47769
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1056 |
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1057 $ hg debugupgraderepo \ |
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1058 --run \ |
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1059 --config format.use-persistent-nodemap=False \ |
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1060 --config storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.slow-path=allow |
6d79894d3460
help: indicate how to run downgrade a repository using persistent nodemap
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47768
diff
changeset
|
1061 |
46337
6e81446bf1d9
share: move share safe functionality out of experimental
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46336
diff
changeset
|
1062 ``use-share-safe`` |
46346
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1063 Enforce "safe" behaviors for all "shares" that access this repository. |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1064 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1065 With this feature, "shares" using this repository as a source will: |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1066 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1067 * read the source repository's configuration (`<source>/.hg/hgrc`). |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1068 * read and use the source repository's "requirements" |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1069 (except the working copy specific one). |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1070 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1071 Without this feature, "shares" using this repository as a source will: |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1072 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1073 * keep tracking the repository "requirements" in the share only, ignoring |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1074 the source "requirements", possibly diverging from them. |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1075 * ignore source repository config. This can create problems, like silently |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1076 ignoring important hooks. |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1077 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1078 Beware that existing shares will not be upgraded/downgraded, and by |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1079 default, Mercurial will refuse to interact with them until the mismatch |
48725
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
1080 is resolved. See :hg:`help config.share.safe-mismatch.source-safe` and |
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
1081 :hg:`help config.share.safe-mismatch.source-not-safe` for details. |
46346
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1082 |
60e6bf3bf681
doc: improves the share-safe documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46345
diff
changeset
|
1083 Introduced in Mercurial 5.7. |
46337
6e81446bf1d9
share: move share safe functionality out of experimental
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46336
diff
changeset
|
1084 |
48669
7ee07e1a25c0
share-safe: enable by default (BC)
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48538
diff
changeset
|
1085 Enabled by default in Mercurial 6.1. |
46337
6e81446bf1d9
share: move share safe functionality out of experimental
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46336
diff
changeset
|
1086 |
49192
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1087 ``use-share-safe.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories`` |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1088 When enabled, an automatic upgrade will be triggered when a repository format |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1089 does not match its `use-share-safe` config. |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1090 |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1091 This is an advanced behavior that most users will not need. We recommend you |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1092 don't use this unless you are a seasoned administrator of a Mercurial install |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1093 base. |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1094 |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1095 Automatic upgrade means that any process accessing the repository will |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1096 upgrade the repository format to use `share-safe`. This only triggers if a |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1097 change is needed. This also applies to operation that would have been |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1098 read-only (like hg status). |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1099 |
49200
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1100 If the repository cannot be locked, the automatic-upgrade operation will be |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1101 skipped. The next operation will attempt it again. |
71774d799de7
auto-upgrade: skip the operation if the repository cannot be locked
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49195
diff
changeset
|
1102 |
49192
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1103 This configuration will apply for moves in any direction, either adding the |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1104 `share-safe` format if `format.use-share-safe=yes` or removing the |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1105 `share-safe` requirement if `format.use-share-safe=no`. So we recommend |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1106 setting both this value and `format.use-share-safe` at the same time. |
2ab79873786e
auto-upgrade: introduce a way to auto-upgrade to/from share-safe
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49050
diff
changeset
|
1107 |
49339
9e203cda3238
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the share-safe message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49200
diff
changeset
|
1108 ``use-share-safe.automatic-upgrade-of-mismatching-repositories:quiet`` |
9e203cda3238
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the share-safe message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49200
diff
changeset
|
1109 Hide message when performing such automatic upgrade. |
9e203cda3238
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the share-safe message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49200
diff
changeset
|
1110 |
27605
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
1111 ``usestore`` |
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
1112 Enable or disable the "store" repository format which improves |
7793b3e220f6
help: sort format section from newest to oldest
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27552
diff
changeset
|
1113 compatibility with systems that fold case or otherwise mangle |
27606
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1114 filenames. Disabling this option will allow you to store longer filenames |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1115 in some situations at the expense of compatibility. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1116 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1117 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 0.9.4. |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1118 |
ebe57ccd4822
help: refactor version/defaults from format section
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27605
diff
changeset
|
1119 Enabled by default. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1120 |
41446
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1121 ``sparse-revlog`` |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1122 Enable or disable the ``sparse-revlog`` delta strategy. This format improves |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1123 delta re-use inside revlog. For very branchy repositories, it results in a |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1124 smaller store. For repositories with many revisions, it also helps |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1125 performance (by using shortened delta chains.) |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1126 |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1127 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 4.7 |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1128 |
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1129 Enabled by default. |
42515
a504aed0a78a
help: add a missing blank line to unhide `revlog-compression`
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
42139
diff
changeset
|
1130 |
42046
4ee906aa7b60
compression: introduce an official `format.revlog-compression` option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42044
diff
changeset
|
1131 ``revlog-compression`` |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1132 Compression algorithm used by revlog. Supported values are `zlib` and |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1133 `zstd`. The `zlib` engine is the historical default of Mercurial. `zstd` is |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1134 a newer format that is usually a net win over `zlib`, operating faster at |
44382
f0027a3dd7cb
revlog-compression: update the config to be a list
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
44110
diff
changeset
|
1135 better compression rates. Use `zstd` to reduce CPU usage. Multiple values |
f0027a3dd7cb
revlog-compression: update the config to be a list
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
44110
diff
changeset
|
1136 can be specified, the first available one will be used. |
44110
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1137 |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1138 On some systems, the Mercurial installation may lack `zstd` support. |
6ae32c12b578
help: minor copy editing to the `config.format` section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
43953
diff
changeset
|
1139 |
46874
84a93fa7ecfd
revlog-compression: use zstd by default (if available)
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46675
diff
changeset
|
1140 Default is `zstd` if available, `zlib` otherwise. |
41446
261d37b94d31
sparserevlog: document the config option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
1141 |
42325
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1142 ``bookmarks-in-store`` |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1143 Store bookmarks in .hg/store/. This means that bookmarks are shared when |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1144 using `hg share` regardless of the `-B` option. |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1145 |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1146 Repositories with this on-disk format require Mercurial version 5.1. |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1147 |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1148 Disabled by default. |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1149 |
526750cdd02d
bookmarks: keep bookmarks in .hg/store if new config set
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
42315
diff
changeset
|
1150 |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1151 ``graph`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1152 --------- |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1153 |
16139
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1154 Web graph view configuration. This section let you change graph |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1155 elements display properties by branches, for instance to make the |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1156 ``default`` branch stand out. |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1157 |
16139
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1158 Each line has the following format:: |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1159 |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1160 <branch>.<argument> = <value> |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1161 |
16139
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1162 where ``<branch>`` is the name of the branch being |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1163 customized. Example:: |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1164 |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1165 [graph] |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1166 # 2px width |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1167 default.width = 2 |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1168 # red color |
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1169 default.color = FF0000 |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1170 |
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1171 Supported arguments: |
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1172 |
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1173 ``width`` |
16139
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1174 Set branch edges width in pixels. |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1175 |
16130
33f702e52906
graph: in hgrc specify line color for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16129
diff
changeset
|
1176 ``color`` |
16139
461a59e2765a
doc: minor fixes to [graph] section documentation
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
16130
diff
changeset
|
1177 Set branch edges color in hexadecimal RGB notation. |
16129
5e50982c633c
graph: in hgrc specify line width for main branch
Constantine Linnick <theaspect@gmail.com>
parents:
16005
diff
changeset
|
1178 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1179 ``hooks`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1180 --------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1181 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1182 Commands or Python functions that get automatically executed by |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1183 various actions such as starting or finishing a commit. Multiple |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1184 hooks can be run for the same action by appending a suffix to the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1185 action. Overriding a site-wide hook can be done by changing its |
15896
30c34fde40cc
hooks: prioritize run order of hooks
Matt Zuba <matt.zuba@goodwillaz.org>
parents:
15612
diff
changeset
|
1186 value or setting it to an empty string. Hooks can be prioritized |
27551
822927d4d930
help: clarify that the config hook priority prefix includes a period
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27266
diff
changeset
|
1187 by adding a prefix of ``priority.`` to the hook name on a new line |
26178 | 1188 and setting the priority. The default priority is 0. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1189 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1190 Example ``.hg/hgrc``:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1191 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1192 [hooks] |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1193 # update working directory after adding changesets |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1194 changegroup.update = hg update |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1195 # do not use the site-wide hook |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1196 incoming = |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1197 incoming.email = /my/email/hook |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1198 incoming.autobuild = /my/build/hook |
15896
30c34fde40cc
hooks: prioritize run order of hooks
Matt Zuba <matt.zuba@goodwillaz.org>
parents:
15612
diff
changeset
|
1199 # force autobuild hook to run before other incoming hooks |
30c34fde40cc
hooks: prioritize run order of hooks
Matt Zuba <matt.zuba@goodwillaz.org>
parents:
15612
diff
changeset
|
1200 priority.incoming.autobuild = 1 |
46492
7289eac777ec
hooks: introduce a `:run-with-plain` option for hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46347
diff
changeset
|
1201 ### control HGPLAIN setting when running autobuild hook |
7289eac777ec
hooks: introduce a `:run-with-plain` option for hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46347
diff
changeset
|
1202 # HGPLAIN always set (default from Mercurial 5.7) |
7289eac777ec
hooks: introduce a `:run-with-plain` option for hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46347
diff
changeset
|
1203 incoming.autobuild:run-with-plain = yes |
7289eac777ec
hooks: introduce a `:run-with-plain` option for hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46347
diff
changeset
|
1204 # HGPLAIN never set |
7289eac777ec
hooks: introduce a `:run-with-plain` option for hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46347
diff
changeset
|
1205 incoming.autobuild:run-with-plain = no |
46522
6c8faeea6652
helptext: fix a recent typo
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
46493
diff
changeset
|
1206 # HGPLAIN inherited from environment (default before Mercurial 5.7) |
46493
b910be772eb9
hooks: add a `auto` value for `hooks.*run-with-plain`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46492
diff
changeset
|
1207 incoming.autobuild:run-with-plain = auto |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1208 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1209 Most hooks are run with environment variables set that give useful |
31746
0fa30fbccc34
hook: provide hook type information to external hook
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31591
diff
changeset
|
1210 additional information. For each hook below, the environment variables |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1211 it is passed are listed with names in the form ``$HG_foo``. The |
31747
aff7b32b3c05
hook: add hook name information to external hook
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31746
diff
changeset
|
1212 ``$HG_HOOKTYPE`` and ``$HG_HOOKNAME`` variables are set for all hooks. |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1213 They contain the type of hook which triggered the run and the full name |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1214 of the hook in the config, respectively. In the example above, this will |
31747
aff7b32b3c05
hook: add hook name information to external hook
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31746
diff
changeset
|
1215 be ``$HG_HOOKTYPE=incoming`` and ``$HG_HOOKNAME=incoming.email``. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1216 |
38484
e9e61fbac787
hooks: allow Unix style environment variables on external Windows hooks
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38260
diff
changeset
|
1217 .. container:: windows |
e9e61fbac787
hooks: allow Unix style environment variables on external Windows hooks
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38260
diff
changeset
|
1218 |
38722
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1219 Some basic Unix syntax can be enabled for portability, including ``$VAR`` |
38725
c382c19ce9bd
windows: expand '~/' and '~\' to %USERPROFILE% when translating to cmd.exe
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38724
diff
changeset
|
1220 and ``${VAR}`` style variables. A ``~`` followed by ``\`` or ``/`` will |
c382c19ce9bd
windows: expand '~/' and '~\' to %USERPROFILE% when translating to cmd.exe
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38724
diff
changeset
|
1221 be expanded to ``%USERPROFILE%`` to simulate a subset of tilde expansion |
c382c19ce9bd
windows: expand '~/' and '~\' to %USERPROFILE% when translating to cmd.exe
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38724
diff
changeset
|
1222 on Unix. To use a literal ``$`` or ``~``, it must be escaped with a back |
c382c19ce9bd
windows: expand '~/' and '~\' to %USERPROFILE% when translating to cmd.exe
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38724
diff
changeset
|
1223 slash or inside of a strong quote. Strong quotes will be replaced by |
c382c19ce9bd
windows: expand '~/' and '~\' to %USERPROFILE% when translating to cmd.exe
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38724
diff
changeset
|
1224 double quotes after processing. |
38722
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1225 |
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1226 This feature is enabled by adding a prefix of ``tonative.`` to the hook |
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1227 name on a new line, and setting it to ``True``. For example:: |
38629
38dfd308fe9d
hook: add support for disabling the shell to native command translation
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38600
diff
changeset
|
1228 |
38dfd308fe9d
hook: add support for disabling the shell to native command translation
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38600
diff
changeset
|
1229 [hooks] |
38dfd308fe9d
hook: add support for disabling the shell to native command translation
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38600
diff
changeset
|
1230 incoming.autobuild = /my/build/hook |
38722
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1231 # enable translation to cmd.exe syntax for autobuild hook |
2009d84f245a
hook: disable the shell to native command translation by default
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38629
diff
changeset
|
1232 tonative.incoming.autobuild = True |
38484
e9e61fbac787
hooks: allow Unix style environment variables on external Windows hooks
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
38260
diff
changeset
|
1233 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1234 ``changegroup`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1235 Run after a changegroup has been added via push, pull or unbundle. The ID of |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1236 the first new changeset is in ``$HG_NODE`` and last is in ``$HG_NODE_LAST``. |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1237 The URL from which changes came is in ``$HG_URL``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1238 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1239 ``commit`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1240 Run after a changeset has been created in the local repository. The ID |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1241 of the newly created changeset is in ``$HG_NODE``. Parent changeset |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1242 IDs are in ``$HG_PARENT1`` and ``$HG_PARENT2``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1243 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1244 ``incoming`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1245 Run after a changeset has been pulled, pushed, or unbundled into |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1246 the local repository. The ID of the newly arrived changeset is in |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1247 ``$HG_NODE``. The URL that was source of the changes is in ``$HG_URL``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1248 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1249 ``outgoing`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1250 Run after sending changes from the local repository to another. The ID of |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1251 first changeset sent is in ``$HG_NODE``. The source of operation is in |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1252 ``$HG_SOURCE``. Also see :hg:`help config.hooks.preoutgoing`. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1253 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1254 ``post-<command>`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1255 Run after successful invocations of the associated command. The |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1256 contents of the command line are passed as ``$HG_ARGS`` and the result |
17680
16ec37411db5
help: removing trailing spaces
Juan Pablo Carbajal (desktop) <carbajal@ifi.uzh.ch>
parents:
17424
diff
changeset
|
1257 code in ``$HG_RESULT``. Parsed command line arguments are passed as |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1258 ``$HG_PATS`` and ``$HG_OPTS``. These contain string representations of |
17680
16ec37411db5
help: removing trailing spaces
Juan Pablo Carbajal (desktop) <carbajal@ifi.uzh.ch>
parents:
17424
diff
changeset
|
1259 the python data internally passed to <command>. ``$HG_OPTS`` is a |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1260 dictionary of options (with unspecified options set to their defaults). |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1261 ``$HG_PATS`` is a list of arguments. Hook failure is ignored. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1262 |
29129
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1263 ``fail-<command>`` |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1264 Run after a failed invocation of an associated command. The contents |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1265 of the command line are passed as ``$HG_ARGS``. Parsed command line |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1266 arguments are passed as ``$HG_PATS`` and ``$HG_OPTS``. These contain |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1267 string representations of the python data internally passed to |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1268 <command>. ``$HG_OPTS`` is a dictionary of options (with unspecified |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1269 options set to their defaults). ``$HG_PATS`` is a list of arguments. |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1270 Hook failure is ignored. |
e6dfb0e4eeef
dispatch: add fail-* family of hooks
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
29070
diff
changeset
|
1271 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1272 ``pre-<command>`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1273 Run before executing the associated command. The contents of the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1274 command line are passed as ``$HG_ARGS``. Parsed command line arguments |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1275 are passed as ``$HG_PATS`` and ``$HG_OPTS``. These contain string |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1276 representations of the data internally passed to <command>. ``$HG_OPTS`` |
27552
20589d3bda6d
help: remove stray double spaces from config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27551
diff
changeset
|
1277 is a dictionary of options (with unspecified options set to their |
17680
16ec37411db5
help: removing trailing spaces
Juan Pablo Carbajal (desktop) <carbajal@ifi.uzh.ch>
parents:
17424
diff
changeset
|
1278 defaults). ``$HG_PATS`` is a list of arguments. If the hook returns |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1279 failure, the command doesn't execute and Mercurial returns the failure |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1280 code. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1281 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1282 ``prechangegroup`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1283 Run before a changegroup is added via push, pull or unbundle. Exit |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1284 status 0 allows the changegroup to proceed. A non-zero status will |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1285 cause the push, pull or unbundle to fail. The URL from which changes |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1286 will come is in ``$HG_URL``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1287 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1288 ``precommit`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1289 Run before starting a local commit. Exit status 0 allows the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1290 commit to proceed. A non-zero status will cause the commit to fail. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1291 Parent changeset IDs are in ``$HG_PARENT1`` and ``$HG_PARENT2``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1292 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1293 ``prelistkeys`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1294 Run before listing pushkeys (like bookmarks) in the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1295 repository. A non-zero status will cause failure. The key namespace is |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1296 in ``$HG_NAMESPACE``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1297 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1298 ``preoutgoing`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1299 Run before collecting changes to send from the local repository to |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1300 another. A non-zero status will cause failure. This lets you prevent |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1301 pull over HTTP or SSH. It can also prevent propagating commits (via |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1302 local pull, push (outbound) or bundle commands), but not completely, |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1303 since you can just copy files instead. The source of operation is in |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1304 ``$HG_SOURCE``. If "serve", the operation is happening on behalf of a remote |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1305 SSH or HTTP repository. If "push", "pull" or "bundle", the operation |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1306 is happening on behalf of a repository on same system. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1307 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1308 ``prepushkey`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1309 Run before a pushkey (like a bookmark) is added to the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1310 repository. A non-zero status will cause the key to be rejected. The |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1311 key namespace is in ``$HG_NAMESPACE``, the key is in ``$HG_KEY``, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1312 the old value (if any) is in ``$HG_OLD``, and the new value is in |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1313 ``$HG_NEW``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1314 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1315 ``pretag`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1316 Run before creating a tag. Exit status 0 allows the tag to be |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1317 created. A non-zero status will cause the tag to fail. The ID of the |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1318 changeset to tag is in ``$HG_NODE``. The name of tag is in ``$HG_TAG``. The |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1319 tag is local if ``$HG_LOCAL=1``, or in the repository if ``$HG_LOCAL=0``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1320 |
24281
e9ede9b4c2f8
hook: have a generic hook for transaction opening
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
23629
diff
changeset
|
1321 ``pretxnopen`` |
e9ede9b4c2f8
hook: have a generic hook for transaction opening
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
23629
diff
changeset
|
1322 Run before any new repository transaction is open. The reason for the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1323 transaction will be in ``$HG_TXNNAME``, and a unique identifier for the |
46967
314386a19cff
help: prepend environment variables used in hooks with "$"
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46905
diff
changeset
|
1324 transaction will be in ``$HG_TXNID``. A non-zero status will prevent the |
24791
89c5881d692c
help: document the ''HG_TXNID'' environment variable during hooks
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24663
diff
changeset
|
1325 transaction from being opened. |
24281
e9ede9b4c2f8
hook: have a generic hook for transaction opening
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
23629
diff
changeset
|
1326 |
24284
ff14b26fe5f4
hook: add a generic hook right before we commit a transaction
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24282
diff
changeset
|
1327 ``pretxnclose`` |
27739
d6d3cf5fda6f
hooks: add HG_NODE_LAST to txnclose and changegroup hook environments
Mateusz Kwapich <mitrandir@fb.com>
parents:
27738
diff
changeset
|
1328 Run right before the transaction is actually finalized. Any repository change |
d6d3cf5fda6f
hooks: add HG_NODE_LAST to txnclose and changegroup hook environments
Mateusz Kwapich <mitrandir@fb.com>
parents:
27738
diff
changeset
|
1329 will be visible to the hook program. This lets you validate the transaction |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1330 content or change it. Exit status 0 allows the commit to proceed. A non-zero |
27739
d6d3cf5fda6f
hooks: add HG_NODE_LAST to txnclose and changegroup hook environments
Mateusz Kwapich <mitrandir@fb.com>
parents:
27738
diff
changeset
|
1331 status will cause the transaction to be rolled back. The reason for the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1332 transaction opening will be in ``$HG_TXNNAME``, and a unique identifier for |
46967
314386a19cff
help: prepend environment variables used in hooks with "$"
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46905
diff
changeset
|
1333 the transaction will be in ``$HG_TXNID``. The rest of the available data will |
46972
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1334 vary according the transaction type. Changes unbundled to the repository will |
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1335 add ``$HG_URL`` and ``$HG_SOURCE``. New changesets will add ``$HG_NODE`` (the |
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1336 ID of the first added changeset), ``$HG_NODE_LAST`` (the ID of the last added |
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1337 changeset). Bookmark and phase changes will set ``$HG_BOOKMARK_MOVED`` and |
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1338 ``$HG_PHASES_MOVED`` to ``1`` respectively. The number of new obsmarkers, if |
6904a9f33b30
help: clarify when `$HG_URL` and `$HG_SOURCE` are added in hooks
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46968
diff
changeset
|
1339 any, will be in ``$HG_NEW_OBSMARKERS``, etc. |
24284
ff14b26fe5f4
hook: add a generic hook right before we commit a transaction
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24282
diff
changeset
|
1340 |
34709
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1341 ``pretxnclose-bookmark`` |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1342 Run right before a bookmark change is actually finalized. Any repository |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1343 change will be visible to the hook program. This lets you validate the |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1344 transaction content or change it. Exit status 0 allows the commit to |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1345 proceed. A non-zero status will cause the transaction to be rolled back. |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1346 The name of the bookmark will be available in ``$HG_BOOKMARK``, the new |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1347 bookmark location will be available in ``$HG_NODE`` while the previous |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1348 location will be available in ``$HG_OLDNODE``. In case of a bookmark |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1349 creation ``$HG_OLDNODE`` will be empty. In case of deletion ``$HG_NODE`` |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1350 will be empty. |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1351 In addition, the reason for the transaction opening will be in |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1352 ``$HG_TXNNAME``, and a unique identifier for the transaction will be in |
46967
314386a19cff
help: prepend environment variables used in hooks with "$"
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46905
diff
changeset
|
1353 ``$HG_TXNID``. |
34709
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1354 |
34711
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1355 ``pretxnclose-phase`` |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1356 Run right before a phase change is actually finalized. Any repository change |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1357 will be visible to the hook program. This lets you validate the transaction |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1358 content or change it. Exit status 0 allows the commit to proceed. A non-zero |
34931
3f8273172636
help: clarify the pre-txnclose-phase documentation
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34872
diff
changeset
|
1359 status will cause the transaction to be rolled back. The hook is called |
3f8273172636
help: clarify the pre-txnclose-phase documentation
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34872
diff
changeset
|
1360 multiple times, once for each revision affected by a phase change. |
34711
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1361 The affected node is available in ``$HG_NODE``, the phase in ``$HG_PHASE`` |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1362 while the previous ``$HG_OLDPHASE``. In case of new node, ``$HG_OLDPHASE`` |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1363 will be empty. In addition, the reason for the transaction opening will be in |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1364 ``$HG_TXNNAME``, and a unique identifier for the transaction will be in |
46967
314386a19cff
help: prepend environment variables used in hooks with "$"
Aay Jay Chan <aayjaychan@itopia.com.hk>
parents:
46905
diff
changeset
|
1365 ``$HG_TXNID``. The hook is also run for newly added revisions. In this case |
34931
3f8273172636
help: clarify the pre-txnclose-phase documentation
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34872
diff
changeset
|
1366 the ``$HG_OLDPHASE`` entry will be empty. |
34711
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1367 |
24282
db8679812f84
hook: add a generic hook after transaction has been closed
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24281
diff
changeset
|
1368 ``txnclose`` |
24814
60e4258b2052
help: fix typo commited -> committed
Javi Merino <merino.jav@gmail.com>
parents:
24792
diff
changeset
|
1369 Run after any repository transaction has been committed. At this |
24282
db8679812f84
hook: add a generic hook after transaction has been closed
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24281
diff
changeset
|
1370 point, the transaction can no longer be rolled back. The hook will run |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1371 after the lock is released. See :hg:`help config.hooks.pretxnclose` for |
26280
5edf3dccb6f7
help/config: use :hg:`help config....` notation
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26279
diff
changeset
|
1372 details about available variables. |
24282
db8679812f84
hook: add a generic hook after transaction has been closed
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24281
diff
changeset
|
1373 |
34708
ee5f0d047b41
bookmark: add a dedicated txnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34705
diff
changeset
|
1374 ``txnclose-bookmark`` |
ee5f0d047b41
bookmark: add a dedicated txnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34705
diff
changeset
|
1375 Run after any bookmark change has been committed. At this point, the |
ee5f0d047b41
bookmark: add a dedicated txnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34705
diff
changeset
|
1376 transaction can no longer be rolled back. The hook will run after the lock |
34709
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1377 is released. See :hg:`help config.hooks.pretxnclose-bookmark` for details |
c212947273a7
bookmark: add a dedicated pretxnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34708
diff
changeset
|
1378 about available variables. |
34708
ee5f0d047b41
bookmark: add a dedicated txnclose-bookmark hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34705
diff
changeset
|
1379 |
34710
cdf833d7de98
phase: add a dedicated txnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34709
diff
changeset
|
1380 ``txnclose-phase`` |
cdf833d7de98
phase: add a dedicated txnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34709
diff
changeset
|
1381 Run after any phase change has been committed. At this point, the |
cdf833d7de98
phase: add a dedicated txnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34709
diff
changeset
|
1382 transaction can no longer be rolled back. The hook will run after the lock |
34711
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1383 is released. See :hg:`help config.hooks.pretxnclose-phase` for details about |
f6d17075608f
phase: add a dedicated pretxnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34710
diff
changeset
|
1384 available variables. |
34710
cdf833d7de98
phase: add a dedicated txnclose-phase hook
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34709
diff
changeset
|
1385 |
24792
7d0421de8de3
hooks: add a 'txnabort' hook
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24791
diff
changeset
|
1386 ``txnabort`` |
28077
27ae22a4f9f9
doc: describe full help document hierarchy to create a valid link in HTML
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
28023
diff
changeset
|
1387 Run when a transaction is aborted. See :hg:`help config.hooks.pretxnclose` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1388 for details about available variables. |
24792
7d0421de8de3
hooks: add a 'txnabort' hook
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
24791
diff
changeset
|
1389 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1390 ``pretxnchangegroup`` |
27739
d6d3cf5fda6f
hooks: add HG_NODE_LAST to txnclose and changegroup hook environments
Mateusz Kwapich <mitrandir@fb.com>
parents:
27738
diff
changeset
|
1391 Run after a changegroup has been added via push, pull or unbundle, but before |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1392 the transaction has been committed. The changegroup is visible to the hook |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1393 program. This allows validation of incoming changes before accepting them. |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1394 The ID of the first new changeset is in ``$HG_NODE`` and last is in |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1395 ``$HG_NODE_LAST``. Exit status 0 allows the transaction to commit. A non-zero |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1396 status will cause the transaction to be rolled back, and the push, pull or |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1397 unbundle will fail. The URL that was the source of changes is in ``$HG_URL``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1398 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1399 ``pretxncommit`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1400 Run after a changeset has been created, but before the transaction is |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1401 committed. The changeset is visible to the hook program. This allows |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1402 validation of the commit message and changes. Exit status 0 allows the |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1403 commit to proceed. A non-zero status will cause the transaction to |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1404 be rolled back. The ID of the new changeset is in ``$HG_NODE``. The parent |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1405 changeset IDs are in ``$HG_PARENT1`` and ``$HG_PARENT2``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1406 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1407 ``preupdate`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1408 Run before updating the working directory. Exit status 0 allows |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1409 the update to proceed. A non-zero status will prevent the update. |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1410 The changeset ID of first new parent is in ``$HG_PARENT1``. If updating to a |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1411 merge, the ID of second new parent is in ``$HG_PARENT2``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1412 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1413 ``listkeys`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1414 Run after listing pushkeys (like bookmarks) in the repository. The |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1415 key namespace is in ``$HG_NAMESPACE``. ``$HG_VALUES`` is a |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1416 dictionary containing the keys and values. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1417 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1418 ``pushkey`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1419 Run after a pushkey (like a bookmark) is added to the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1420 repository. The key namespace is in ``$HG_NAMESPACE``, the key is in |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1421 ``$HG_KEY``, the old value (if any) is in ``$HG_OLD``, and the new |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1422 value is in ``$HG_NEW``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1423 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1424 ``tag`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1425 Run after a tag is created. The ID of the tagged changeset is in ``$HG_NODE``. |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1426 The name of tag is in ``$HG_TAG``. The tag is local if ``$HG_LOCAL=1``, or in |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1427 the repository if ``$HG_LOCAL=0``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1428 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1429 ``update`` |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1430 Run after updating the working directory. The changeset ID of first |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1431 new parent is in ``$HG_PARENT1``. If updating to a merge, the ID of second new |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1432 parent is in ``$HG_PARENT2``. If the update succeeded, ``$HG_ERROR=0``. If the |
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1433 update failed (e.g. because conflicts were not resolved), ``$HG_ERROR=1``. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1434 |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1435 .. note:: |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1436 |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1437 It is generally better to use standard hooks rather than the |
33170
26c49ed51a69
help: cleanup grammar in the hooks section
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
1438 generic pre- and post- command hooks, as they are guaranteed to be |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1439 called in the appropriate contexts for influencing transactions. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1440 Also, hooks like "commit" will be called in all contexts that |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1441 generate a commit (e.g. tag) and not just the commit command. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1442 |
20532
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1443 .. note:: |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1444 |
f1a3ae7c15df
help: remove last occurrences of ".. note::" without two newlines
Simon Heimberg <simohe@besonet.ch>
parents:
20490
diff
changeset
|
1445 Environment variables with empty values may not be passed to |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1446 hooks on platforms such as Windows. As an example, ``$HG_PARENT2`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1447 will have an empty value under Unix-like platforms for non-merge |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1448 changesets, while it will not be available at all under Windows. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1449 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1450 The syntax for Python hooks is as follows:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1451 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1452 hookname = python:modulename.submodule.callable |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1453 hookname = python:/path/to/python/module.py:callable |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1454 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1455 Python hooks are run within the Mercurial process. Each hook is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1456 called with at least three keyword arguments: a ui object (keyword |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1457 ``ui``), a repository object (keyword ``repo``), and a ``hooktype`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1458 keyword that tells what kind of hook is used. Arguments listed as |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1459 environment variables above are passed as keyword arguments, with no |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1460 ``HG_`` prefix, and names in lower case. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1461 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1462 If a Python hook returns a "true" value or raises an exception, this |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1463 is treated as a failure. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1464 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1465 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1466 ``hostfingerprints`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1467 -------------------- |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1468 |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1469 (Deprecated. Use ``[hostsecurity]``'s ``fingerprints`` options instead.) |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1470 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1471 Fingerprints of the certificates of known HTTPS servers. |
28524
ce1160ae2150
help: add empty lines to hostfingerprints section
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28218
diff
changeset
|
1472 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1473 A HTTPS connection to a server with a fingerprint configured here will |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1474 only succeed if the servers certificate matches the fingerprint. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1475 This is very similar to how ssh known hosts works. |
28524
ce1160ae2150
help: add empty lines to hostfingerprints section
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28218
diff
changeset
|
1476 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1477 The fingerprint is the SHA-1 hash value of the DER encoded certificate. |
28525
dfb21c34e07d
sslutil: allow multiple fingerprints per host
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28524
diff
changeset
|
1478 Multiple values can be specified (separated by spaces or commas). This can |
dfb21c34e07d
sslutil: allow multiple fingerprints per host
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28524
diff
changeset
|
1479 be used to define both old and new fingerprints while a host transitions |
dfb21c34e07d
sslutil: allow multiple fingerprints per host
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28524
diff
changeset
|
1480 to a new certificate. |
28524
ce1160ae2150
help: add empty lines to hostfingerprints section
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
28218
diff
changeset
|
1481 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1482 The CA chain and web.cacerts is not used for servers with a fingerprint. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1483 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1484 For example:: |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1485 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1486 [hostfingerprints] |
28191
535f2900d078
help: hg.intevation.de is new primary name of hg.intevation.de (and new cert)
Thomas Arendsen Hein <thomas@intevation.de>
parents:
28057
diff
changeset
|
1487 hg.intevation.de = fc:e2:8d:d9:51:cd:cb:c1:4d:18:6b:b7:44:8d:49:72:57:e6:cd:33 |
535f2900d078
help: hg.intevation.de is new primary name of hg.intevation.de (and new cert)
Thomas Arendsen Hein <thomas@intevation.de>
parents:
28057
diff
changeset
|
1488 hg.intevation.org = fc:e2:8d:d9:51:cd:cb:c1:4d:18:6b:b7:44:8d:49:72:57:e6:cd:33 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1489 |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1490 ``hostsecurity`` |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1491 ---------------- |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1492 |
29559
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1493 Used to specify global and per-host security settings for connecting to |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1494 other machines. |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1495 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1496 The following options control default behavior for all hosts. |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1497 |
29577
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1498 ``ciphers`` |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1499 Defines the cryptographic ciphers to use for connections. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1500 |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1501 Value must be a valid OpenSSL Cipher List Format as documented at |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1502 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1503 |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1504 This setting is for advanced users only. Setting to incorrect values |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1505 can significantly lower connection security or decrease performance. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1506 You have been warned. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1507 |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1508 This option requires Python 2.7. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1509 |
29559
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1510 ``minimumprotocol`` |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1511 Defines the minimum channel encryption protocol to use. |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1512 |
29560
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1513 By default, the highest version of TLS supported by both client and server |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1514 is used. |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1515 |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1516 Allowed values are: ``tls1.0``, ``tls1.1``, ``tls1.2``. |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1517 |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1518 When running on an old Python version, only ``tls1.0`` is allowed since |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1519 old versions of Python only support up to TLS 1.0. |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1520 |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1521 When running a Python that supports modern TLS versions, the default is |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1522 ``tls1.1``. ``tls1.0`` can still be used to allow TLS 1.0. However, this |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1523 weakens security and should only be used as a feature of last resort if |
303e9300772a
sslutil: require TLS 1.1+ when supported
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29559
diff
changeset
|
1524 a server does not support TLS 1.1+. |
29559
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1525 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1526 Options in the ``[hostsecurity]`` section can have the form |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1527 ``hostname``:``setting``. This allows multiple settings to be defined on a |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1528 per-host basis. |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1529 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1530 The following per-host settings can be defined. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1531 |
29577
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1532 ``ciphers`` |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1533 This behaves like ``ciphers`` as described above except it only applies |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1534 to the host on which it is defined. |
9654ef41f7cc
sslutil: support defining cipher list
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29560
diff
changeset
|
1535 |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1536 ``fingerprints`` |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1537 A list of hashes of the DER encoded peer/remote certificate. Values have |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1538 the form ``algorithm``:``fingerprint``. e.g. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1539 ``sha256:c3ab8ff13720e8ad9047dd39466b3c8974e592c2fa383d4a3960714caef0c4f2``. |
32274
2b017d22fe97
help: clarify that colons are allowed in fingerprints values
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32260
diff
changeset
|
1540 In addition, colons (``:``) can appear in the fingerprint part. |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1541 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1542 The following algorithms/prefixes are supported: ``sha1``, ``sha256``, |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1543 ``sha512``. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1544 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1545 Use of ``sha256`` or ``sha512`` is preferred. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1546 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1547 If a fingerprint is specified, the CA chain is not validated for this |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1548 host and Mercurial will require the remote certificate to match one |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1549 of the fingerprints specified. This means if the server updates its |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1550 certificate, Mercurial will abort until a new fingerprint is defined. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1551 This can provide stronger security than traditional CA-based validation |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1552 at the expense of convenience. |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1553 |
29334
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1554 This option takes precedence over ``verifycertsfile``. |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1555 |
29559
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1556 ``minimumprotocol`` |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1557 This behaves like ``minimumprotocol`` as described above except it |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1558 only applies to the host on which it is defined. |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1559 |
29334
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1560 ``verifycertsfile`` |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1561 Path to file a containing a list of PEM encoded certificates used to |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1562 verify the server certificate. Environment variables and ``~user`` |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1563 constructs are expanded in the filename. |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1564 |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1565 The server certificate or the certificate's certificate authority (CA) |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1566 must match a certificate from this file or certificate verification |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1567 will fail and connections to the server will be refused. |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1568 |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1569 If defined, only certificates provided by this file will be used: |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1570 ``web.cacerts`` and any system/default certificates will not be |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1571 used. |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1572 |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1573 This option has no effect if the per-host ``fingerprints`` option |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1574 is set. |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1575 |
29649
512611246ea4
doc: make previous line of certificate example end with "::"
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
29648
diff
changeset
|
1576 The format of the file is as follows:: |
29334
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1577 |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1578 -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE----- |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1579 ... (certificate in base64 PEM encoding) ... |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1580 -----END CERTIFICATE----- |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1581 -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE----- |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1582 ... (certificate in base64 PEM encoding) ... |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1583 -----END CERTIFICATE----- |
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1584 |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1585 For example:: |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1586 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1587 [hostsecurity] |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1588 hg.example.com:fingerprints = sha256:c3ab8ff13720e8ad9047dd39466b3c8974e592c2fa383d4a3960714caef0c4f2 |
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1589 hg2.example.com:fingerprints = sha1:914f1aff87249c09b6859b88b1906d30756491ca, sha1:fc:e2:8d:d9:51:cd:cb:c1:4d:18:6b:b7:44:8d:49:72:57:e6:cd:33 |
32274
2b017d22fe97
help: clarify that colons are allowed in fingerprints values
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32260
diff
changeset
|
1590 hg3.example.com:fingerprints = sha256:9a:b0:dc:e2:75:ad:8a:b7:84:58:e5:1f:07:32:f1:87:e6:bd:24:22:af:b7:ce:8e:9c:b4:10:cf:b9:f4:0e:d2 |
29334
ecc9b788fd69
sslutil: per-host config option to define certificates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29285
diff
changeset
|
1591 foo.example.com:verifycertsfile = /etc/ssl/trusted-ca-certs.pem |
29267
f0ccb6cde3e5
sslutil: allow fingerprints to be specified in [hostsecurity]
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29129
diff
changeset
|
1592 |
29559
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1593 To change the default minimum protocol version to TLS 1.2 but to allow TLS 1.1 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1594 when connecting to ``hg.example.com``:: |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1595 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1596 [hostsecurity] |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1597 minimumprotocol = tls1.2 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1598 hg.example.com:minimumprotocol = tls1.1 |
7dec5e441bf7
sslutil: config option to specify TLS protocol version
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29471
diff
changeset
|
1599 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1600 ``http_proxy`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1601 -------------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1602 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1603 Used to access web-based Mercurial repositories through a HTTP |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1604 proxy. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1605 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1606 ``host`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1607 Host name and (optional) port of the proxy server, for example |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1608 "myproxy:8000". |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1609 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1610 ``no`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1611 Optional. Comma-separated list of host names that should bypass |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1612 the proxy. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1613 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1614 ``passwd`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1615 Optional. Password to authenticate with at the proxy server. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1616 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1617 ``user`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1618 Optional. User name to authenticate with at the proxy server. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1619 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1620 ``always`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1621 Optional. Always use the proxy, even for localhost and any entries |
26279 | 1622 in ``http_proxy.no``. (default: False) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1623 |
40043
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1624 ``http`` |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1625 ---------- |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1626 |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1627 Used to configure access to Mercurial repositories via HTTP. |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1628 |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1629 ``timeout`` |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1630 If set, blocking operations will timeout after that many seconds. |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1631 (default: None) |
6509fcec830c
url: allow to configure timeout on http connection
Cédric Krier <ced@b2ck.com>
parents:
39792
diff
changeset
|
1632 |
28023
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1633 ``merge`` |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1634 --------- |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1635 |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1636 This section specifies behavior during merges and updates. |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1637 |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1638 ``checkignored`` |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1639 Controls behavior when an ignored file on disk has the same name as a tracked |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1640 file in the changeset being merged or updated to, and has different |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1641 contents. Options are ``abort``, ``warn`` and ``ignore``. With ``abort``, |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1642 abort on such files. With ``warn``, warn on such files and back them up as |
29060
db74d95299af
help: wrap ".orig" in rst quotes
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
28957
diff
changeset
|
1643 ``.orig``. With ``ignore``, don't print a warning and back them up as |
db74d95299af
help: wrap ".orig" in rst quotes
Sean Farley <sean@farley.io>
parents:
28957
diff
changeset
|
1644 ``.orig``. (default: ``abort``) |
28023
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1645 |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1646 ``checkunknown`` |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1647 Controls behavior when an unknown file that isn't ignored has the same name |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1648 as a tracked file in the changeset being merged or updated to, and has |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1649 different contents. Similar to ``merge.checkignored``, except for files that |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1650 are not ignored. (default: ``abort``) |
b7bf2b0731be
merge: document checkignored and checkunknown configs again
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
27986
diff
changeset
|
1651 |
34796
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1652 ``on-failure`` |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1653 When set to ``continue`` (the default), the merge process attempts to |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1654 merge all unresolved files using the merge chosen tool, regardless of |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1655 whether previous file merge attempts during the process succeeded or not. |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1656 Setting this to ``prompt`` will prompt after any merge failure continue |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1657 or halt the merge process. Setting this to ``halt`` will automatically |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1658 halt the merge process on any merge tool failure. The merge process |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1659 can be restarted by using the ``resolve`` command. When a merge is |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1660 halted, the repository is left in a normal ``unresolved`` merge state. |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1661 (default: ``continue``) |
ed91846c29cf
filemerge: introduce functions to halt merge flow
Ryan McElroy <rmcelroy@fb.com>
parents:
34711
diff
changeset
|
1662 |
39125
cded904f7acc
filemerge: add config knob to check capabilities of internal merge tools
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
38875
diff
changeset
|
1663 ``strict-capability-check`` |
cded904f7acc
filemerge: add config knob to check capabilities of internal merge tools
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
38875
diff
changeset
|
1664 Whether capabilities of internal merge tools are checked strictly |
cded904f7acc
filemerge: add config knob to check capabilities of internal merge tools
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
38875
diff
changeset
|
1665 or not, while examining rules to decide merge tool to be used. |
cded904f7acc
filemerge: add config knob to check capabilities of internal merge tools
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
38875
diff
changeset
|
1666 (default: False) |
cded904f7acc
filemerge: add config knob to check capabilities of internal merge tools
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
38875
diff
changeset
|
1667 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1668 ``merge-patterns`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1669 ------------------ |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1670 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1671 This section specifies merge tools to associate with particular file |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1672 patterns. Tools matched here will take precedence over the default |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1673 merge tool. Patterns are globs by default, rooted at the repository |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1674 root. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1675 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1676 Example:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1677 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1678 [merge-patterns] |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1679 **.c = kdiff3 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1680 **.jpg = myimgmerge |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1681 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1682 ``merge-tools`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1683 --------------- |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1684 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1685 This section configures external merge tools to use for file-level |
21402
c915d066bcac
help: add additional information in the merge-tools section of config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
20532
diff
changeset
|
1686 merges. This section has likely been preconfigured at install time. |
c915d066bcac
help: add additional information in the merge-tools section of config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
20532
diff
changeset
|
1687 Use :hg:`config merge-tools` to check the existing configuration. |
c915d066bcac
help: add additional information in the merge-tools section of config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
20532
diff
changeset
|
1688 Also see :hg:`help merge-tools` for more details. |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1689 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1690 Example ``~/.hgrc``:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1691 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1692 [merge-tools] |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1693 # Override stock tool location |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1694 kdiff3.executable = ~/bin/kdiff3 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1695 # Specify command line |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1696 kdiff3.args = $base $local $other -o $output |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1697 # Give higher priority |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1698 kdiff3.priority = 1 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1699 |
21403
3db723e2dc20
doc: improves merge-tools example with an overwrite of existing config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
21402
diff
changeset
|
1700 # Changing the priority of preconfigured tool |
26730
a1e43e85d294
merge-tools: allow marking a mergetool as completely disabled
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
26625
diff
changeset
|
1701 meld.priority = 0 |
a1e43e85d294
merge-tools: allow marking a mergetool as completely disabled
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
26625
diff
changeset
|
1702 |
a1e43e85d294
merge-tools: allow marking a mergetool as completely disabled
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
26625
diff
changeset
|
1703 # Disable a preconfigured tool |
a1e43e85d294
merge-tools: allow marking a mergetool as completely disabled
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
26625
diff
changeset
|
1704 vimdiff.disabled = yes |
21403
3db723e2dc20
doc: improves merge-tools example with an overwrite of existing config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
21402
diff
changeset
|
1705 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1706 # Define new tool |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1707 myHtmlTool.args = -m $local $other $base $output |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1708 myHtmlTool.regkey = Software\FooSoftware\HtmlMerge |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1709 myHtmlTool.priority = 1 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1710 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1711 Supported arguments: |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1712 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1713 ``priority`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1714 The priority in which to evaluate this tool. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1715 (default: 0) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1716 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1717 ``executable`` |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1718 Either just the name of the executable or its pathname. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1719 |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1720 .. container:: windows |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1721 |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1722 On Windows, the path can use environment variables with ${ProgramFiles} |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1723 syntax. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1724 |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1725 (default: the tool name) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1726 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1727 ``args`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1728 The arguments to pass to the tool executable. You can refer to the |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1729 files being merged as well as the output file through these |
35907
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1730 variables: ``$base``, ``$local``, ``$other``, ``$output``. |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1731 |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1732 The meaning of ``$local`` and ``$other`` can vary depending on which action is |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1733 being performed. During an update or merge, ``$local`` represents the original |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1734 state of the file, while ``$other`` represents the commit you are updating to or |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1735 the commit you are merging with. During a rebase, ``$local`` represents the |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1736 destination of the rebase, and ``$other`` represents the commit being rebased. |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1737 |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1738 Some operations define custom labels to assist with identifying the revisions, |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1739 accessible via ``$labellocal``, ``$labelother``, and ``$labelbase``. If custom |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1740 labels are not available, these will be ``local``, ``other``, and ``base``, |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1741 respectively. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1742 (default: ``$local $base $other``) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1743 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1744 ``premerge`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1745 Attempt to run internal non-interactive 3-way merge tool before |
46139
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1746 launching external tool. Options are ``true``, ``false``, ``keep``, |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1747 ``keep-merge3``, or ``keep-mergediff`` (experimental). The ``keep`` option |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1748 will leave markers in the file if the premerge fails. The ``keep-merge3`` |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1749 will do the same but include information about the base of the merge in the |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1750 marker (see internal :merge3 in :hg:`help merge-tools`). The |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1751 ``keep-mergediff`` option is similar but uses a different marker style |
3ca5ca380a34
filemerge: add support for the new "mergediff" marker style to premerge
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
46008
diff
changeset
|
1752 (see internal :merge3 in :hg:`help merge-tools`). (default: True) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1753 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1754 ``binary`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1755 This tool can merge binary files. (default: False, unless tool |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1756 was selected by file pattern match) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1757 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1758 ``symlink`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1759 This tool can merge symlinks. (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1760 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1761 ``check`` |
26225
e257df7a9974
help/config: back out 5f2a1ebd6e78
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
26182
diff
changeset
|
1762 A list of merge success-checking options: |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1763 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1764 ``changed`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1765 Ask whether merge was successful when the merged file shows no changes. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1766 ``conflicts`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1767 Check whether there are conflicts even though the tool reported success. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1768 ``prompt`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1769 Always prompt for merge success, regardless of success reported by tool. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1770 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1771 ``fixeol`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1772 Attempt to fix up EOL changes caused by the merge tool. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1773 (default: False) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1774 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1775 ``gui`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1776 This tool requires a graphical interface to run. (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1777 |
35907
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1778 ``mergemarkers`` |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1779 Controls whether the labels passed via ``$labellocal``, ``$labelother``, and |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1780 ``$labelbase`` are ``detailed`` (respecting ``mergemarkertemplate``) or |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1781 ``basic``. If ``premerge`` is ``keep`` or ``keep-merge3``, the conflict |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1782 markers generated during premerge will be ``detailed`` if either this option or |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1783 the corresponding option in the ``[ui]`` section is ``detailed``. |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1784 (default: ``basic``) |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1785 |
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1786 ``mergemarkertemplate`` |
45767
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
1787 This setting can be used to override ``mergemarker`` from the |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
1788 ``[command-templates]`` section on a per-tool basis; this applies to the |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
1789 ``$label``-prefixed variables and to the conflict markers that are generated |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
1790 if ``premerge`` is ``keep` or ``keep-merge3``. See the corresponding variable |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
1791 in ``[ui]`` for more information. |
35907
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
1792 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1793 .. container:: windows |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1794 |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1795 ``regkey`` |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1796 Windows registry key which describes install location of this |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1797 tool. Mercurial will search for this key first under |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1798 ``HKEY_CURRENT_USER`` and then under ``HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE``. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1799 (default: None) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1800 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1801 ``regkeyalt`` |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1802 An alternate Windows registry key to try if the first key is not |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1803 found. The alternate key uses the same ``regname`` and ``regappend`` |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1804 semantics of the primary key. The most common use for this key |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1805 is to search for 32bit applications on 64bit operating systems. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1806 (default: None) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1807 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1808 ``regname`` |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1809 Name of value to read from specified registry key. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1810 (default: the unnamed (default) value) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
1811 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1812 ``regappend`` |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1813 String to append to the value read from the registry, typically |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1814 the executable name of the tool. |
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
1815 (default: None) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1816 |
32099
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1817 ``pager`` |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1818 --------- |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1819 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1820 Setting used to control when to paginate and with what external tool. See |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1821 :hg:`help pager` for details. |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1822 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1823 ``pager`` |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1824 Define the external tool used as pager. |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1825 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1826 If no pager is set, Mercurial uses the environment variable $PAGER. |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1827 If neither pager.pager, nor $PAGER is set, a default pager will be |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1828 used, typically `less` on Unix and `more` on Windows. Example:: |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1829 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1830 [pager] |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1831 pager = less -FRX |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1832 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1833 ``ignore`` |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1834 List of commands to disable the pager for. Example:: |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1835 |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1836 [pager] |
7c76f3923b6a
pager: document the 'pager' config section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32090
diff
changeset
|
1837 ignore = version, help, update |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1838 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1839 ``patch`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1840 --------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1841 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1842 Settings used when applying patches, for instance through the 'import' |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1843 command or with Mercurial Queues extension. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1844 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1845 ``eol`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1846 When set to 'strict' patch content and patched files end of lines |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1847 are preserved. When set to ``lf`` or ``crlf``, both files end of |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1848 lines are ignored when patching and the result line endings are |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1849 normalized to either LF (Unix) or CRLF (Windows). When set to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1850 ``auto``, end of lines are again ignored while patching but line |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1851 endings in patched files are normalized to their original setting |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1852 on a per-file basis. If target file does not exist or has no end |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1853 of line, patch line endings are preserved. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1854 (default: strict) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1855 |
25631
2748bf78a5bf
patch: add fuzz config flag (issue4697)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25523
diff
changeset
|
1856 ``fuzz`` |
2748bf78a5bf
patch: add fuzz config flag (issue4697)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25523
diff
changeset
|
1857 The number of lines of 'fuzz' to allow when applying patches. This |
2748bf78a5bf
patch: add fuzz config flag (issue4697)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25523
diff
changeset
|
1858 controls how much context the patcher is allowed to ignore when |
2748bf78a5bf
patch: add fuzz config flag (issue4697)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25523
diff
changeset
|
1859 trying to apply a patch. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1860 (default: 2) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1861 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1862 ``paths`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1863 --------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1864 |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1865 Assigns symbolic names and behavior to repositories. |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1866 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1867 Options are symbolic names defining the URL or directory that is the |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1868 location of the repository. Example:: |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1869 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1870 [paths] |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1871 my_server = https://example.com/my_repo |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1872 local_path = /home/me/repo |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1873 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1874 These symbolic names can be used from the command line. To pull |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1875 from ``my_server``: :hg:`pull my_server`. To push to ``local_path``: |
46904
ede52e19c752
help: point to `hg help urls` in `hg help config.paths`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46884
diff
changeset
|
1876 :hg:`push local_path`. You can check :hg:`help urls` for details about |
ede52e19c752
help: point to `hg help urls` in `hg help config.paths`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46884
diff
changeset
|
1877 valid URLs. |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1878 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1879 Options containing colons (``:``) denote sub-options that can influence |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1880 behavior for that specific path. Example:: |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1881 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1882 [paths] |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1883 my_server = https://example.com/my_path |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1884 my_server:pushurl = ssh://example.com/my_path |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1885 |
46905
95a5ed7db9ca
help: document the `path://` url scheme
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46904
diff
changeset
|
1886 Paths using the `path://otherpath` scheme will inherit the sub-options value from |
95a5ed7db9ca
help: document the `path://` url scheme
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46904
diff
changeset
|
1887 the path they point to. |
95a5ed7db9ca
help: document the `path://` url scheme
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46904
diff
changeset
|
1888 |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1889 The following sub-options can be defined: |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1890 |
47274
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1891 ``multi-urls`` |
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1892 A boolean option. When enabled the value of the `[paths]` entry will be |
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1893 parsed as a list and the alias will resolve to multiple destination. If some |
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1894 of the list entry use the `path://` syntax, the suboption will be inherited |
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1895 individually. |
0470a44b9e74
multi-urls: document the feature
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47071
diff
changeset
|
1896 |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1897 ``pushurl`` |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1898 The URL to use for push operations. If not defined, the location |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1899 defined by the path's main entry is used. |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1900 |
29413
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1901 ``pushrev`` |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1902 A revset defining which revisions to push by default. |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1903 |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1904 When :hg:`push` is executed without a ``-r`` argument, the revset |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1905 defined by this sub-option is evaluated to determine what to push. |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1906 |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1907 For example, a value of ``.`` will push the working directory's |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1908 revision by default. |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1909 |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1910 Revsets specifying bookmarks will not result in the bookmark being |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1911 pushed. |
31d3ab7985b8
ui: path option to declare which revisions to push by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29334
diff
changeset
|
1912 |
48242
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1913 ``bookmarks.mode`` |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1914 How bookmark will be dealt during the exchange. It support the following value |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1915 |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1916 - ``default``: the default behavior, local and remote bookmarks are "merged" |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1917 on push/pull. |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1918 |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1919 - ``mirror``: when pulling, replace local bookmarks by remote bookmarks. This |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1920 is useful to replicate a repository, or as an optimization. |
4d2ab365699e
bookmarks: move the `mirror` option to the `paths` section
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48033
diff
changeset
|
1921 |
48244
b56858d85a7b
bookmarks: add a `ignore` variant of the bookmark mode
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48242
diff
changeset
|
1922 - ``ignore``: ignore bookmarks during exchange. |
b56858d85a7b
bookmarks: add a `ignore` variant of the bookmark mode
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48242
diff
changeset
|
1923 (This currently only affect pulling) |
b56858d85a7b
bookmarks: add a `ignore` variant of the bookmark mode
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48242
diff
changeset
|
1924 |
49767
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1925 .. container:: verbose |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1926 |
50207
f35cf52acabd
delta-find: rename `delta-reuse-policy` to `pulled-delta-reuse-policy`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49768
diff
changeset
|
1927 ``pulled-delta-reuse-policy`` |
49767
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1928 Control the policy regarding deltas sent by the remote during pulls. |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1929 |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1930 This is an advanced option that non-admin users should not need to understand |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1931 or set. This option can be used to speed up pulls from trusted central |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1932 servers, or to fix-up deltas from older servers. |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1933 |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1934 It supports the following values: |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1935 |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1936 - ``default``: use the policy defined by |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1937 `storage.revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent`, |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1938 |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1939 - ``no-reuse``: start a new optimal delta search for each new revision we add |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1940 to the repository. The deltas from the server will be reused when the base |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1941 it applies to is tested (this can be frequent if that base is the one and |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1942 unique parent of that revision). This can significantly slowdown pulls but |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1943 will result in an optimized storage space if the remote peer is sending poor |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1944 quality deltas. |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1945 |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1946 - ``try-base``: try to reuse the deltas from the remote peer as long as they |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1947 create a valid delta-chain in the local repository. This speeds up the |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1948 unbundling process, but can result in sub-optimal storage space if the |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1949 remote peer is sending poor quality deltas. |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1950 |
49768
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1951 - ``forced``: the deltas from the peer will be reused in all cases, even if |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1952 the resulting delta-chain is "invalid". This setting will ensure the bundle |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1953 is applied at minimal CPU cost, but it can result in longer delta chains |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1954 being created on the client, making revisions potentially slower to access |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1955 in the future. If you think you need this option, you should make sure you |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1956 are also talking to the Mercurial developer community to get confirmation. |
bcae90c53def
delta-find: add a delta-reuse policy that blindly accepts incoming deltas
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49767
diff
changeset
|
1957 |
49767
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1958 See `hg help config.storage.revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` for a similar |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1959 global option. That option defines the behavior of `default`. |
f1887500f3ec
delta-find: add a `delta-reuse-policy` on configuration `path`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49657
diff
changeset
|
1960 |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1961 The following special named paths exist: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1962 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1963 ``default`` |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1964 The URL or directory to use when no source or remote is specified. |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1965 |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1966 :hg:`clone` will automatically define this path to the location the |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1967 repository was cloned from. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
1968 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1969 ``default-push`` |
27266
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1970 (deprecated) The URL or directory for the default :hg:`push` location. |
4dccc37b87bd
ui: support declaring path push urls as sub-options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27246
diff
changeset
|
1971 ``default:pushurl`` should be used instead. |
17685
8fcef9614150
help: add example of paths other than default in hgrc
Juan Pablo Carbajal (desktop) <carbajal@ifi.uzh.ch>
parents:
17680
diff
changeset
|
1972 |
15999
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1973 ``phases`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
1974 ---------- |
15999
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1975 |
16005
591f258ae630
help/config: fix help command markup
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
15999
diff
changeset
|
1976 Specifies default handling of phases. See :hg:`help phases` for more |
15999
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1977 information about working with phases. |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1978 |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1979 ``publish`` |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1980 Controls draft phase behavior when working as a server. When true, |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1981 pushed changesets are set to public in both client and server and |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1982 pulled or cloned changesets are set to public in the client. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1983 (default: True) |
15999
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1984 |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1985 ``new-commit`` |
76625324bd55
help: add missing phase config items to config topic
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
1986 Phase of newly-created commits. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1987 (default: draft) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
1988 |
20176
4c96c50ef937
subrepo: check phase of state in each subrepositories before committing
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
20142
diff
changeset
|
1989 ``checksubrepos`` |
20333
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1990 Check the phase of the current revision of each subrepository. Allowed |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1991 values are "ignore", "follow" and "abort". For settings other than |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1992 "ignore", the phase of the current revision of each subrepository is |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1993 checked before committing the parent repository. If any of those phases is |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1994 greater than the phase of the parent repository (e.g. if a subrepo is in a |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1995 "secret" phase while the parent repo is in "draft" phase), the commit is |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1996 either aborted (if checksubrepos is set to "abort") or the higher phase is |
fa6cb300ded4
help: improve description of phases.checksubrepos setting
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
20176
diff
changeset
|
1997 used for the parent repository commit (if set to "follow"). |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
1998 (default: follow) |
20176
4c96c50ef937
subrepo: check phase of state in each subrepositories before committing
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
20142
diff
changeset
|
1999 |
4c96c50ef937
subrepo: check phase of state in each subrepositories before committing
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
20142
diff
changeset
|
2000 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2001 ``profiling`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2002 ------------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2003 |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2004 Specifies profiling type, format, and file output. Two profilers are |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2005 supported: an instrumenting profiler (named ``ls``), and a sampling |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2006 profiler (named ``stat``). |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2007 |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2008 In this section description, 'profiling data' stands for the raw data |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2009 collected during profiling, while 'profiling report' stands for a |
36696
0c431d3129c4
docs: small fixes for profiling.nested and the overall description
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35907
diff
changeset
|
2010 statistical text report generated from the profiling data. |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2011 |
29784
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2012 ``enabled`` |
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2013 Enable the profiler. |
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2014 (default: false) |
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2015 |
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2016 This is equivalent to passing ``--profile`` on the command line. |
e3501546f7e4
profiling: add a context manager that no-ops if profiling isn't enabled
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29780
diff
changeset
|
2017 |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2018 ``type`` |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2019 The type of profiler to use. |
30317
3fd53cc1aad8
profiling: make statprof the default profiler (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30316
diff
changeset
|
2020 (default: stat) |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2021 |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2022 ``ls`` |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2023 Use Python's built-in instrumenting profiler. This profiler |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2024 works on all platforms, but each line number it reports is the |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2025 first line of a function. This restriction makes it difficult to |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2026 identify the expensive parts of a non-trivial function. |
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2027 ``stat`` |
30316
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2028 Use a statistical profiler, statprof. This profiler is most |
30347
494d5cec0b07
help: fix double word usage
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30317
diff
changeset
|
2029 useful for profiling commands that run for longer than about 0.1 |
494d5cec0b07
help: fix double word usage
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30317
diff
changeset
|
2030 seconds. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2031 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2032 ``format`` |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2033 Profiling format. Specific to the ``ls`` instrumenting profiler. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2034 (default: text) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2035 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2036 ``text`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2037 Generate a profiling report. When saving to a file, it should be |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2038 noted that only the report is saved, and the profiling data is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2039 not kept. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2040 ``kcachegrind`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2041 Format profiling data for kcachegrind use: when saving to a |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2042 file, the generated file can directly be loaded into |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2043 kcachegrind. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2044 |
30316
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2045 ``statformat`` |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2046 Profiling format for the ``stat`` profiler. |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2047 (default: hotpath) |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2048 |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2049 ``hotpath`` |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2050 Show a tree-based display containing the hot path of execution (where |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2051 most time was spent). |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2052 ``bymethod`` |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2053 Show a table of methods ordered by how frequently they are active. |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2054 ``byline`` |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2055 Show a table of lines in files ordered by how frequently they are active. |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2056 ``json`` |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2057 Render profiling data as JSON. |
faf1b8923da2
profiling: use vendored statprof and upstream enhancements (BC)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29784
diff
changeset
|
2058 |
47777
1a174f122814
help: correct config.profiling.freq name (frequency->freq)
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
47769
diff
changeset
|
2059 ``freq`` |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2060 Sampling frequency. Specific to the ``stat`` sampling profiler. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2061 (default: 1000) |
16392
ee3f423df1b4
dispatch: add support for statprof as a profiler
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
16391
diff
changeset
|
2062 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2063 ``output`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2064 File path where profiling data or report should be saved. If the |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2065 file exists, it is replaced. (default: None, data is printed on |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2066 stderr) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2067 |
18502
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2068 ``sort`` |
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2069 Sort field. Specific to the ``ls`` instrumenting profiler. |
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2070 One of ``callcount``, ``reccallcount``, ``totaltime`` and |
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2071 ``inlinetime``. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2072 (default: inlinetime) |
18502
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2073 |
38260
15a1e37f80bd
profiling: introduce a "profiling.time-track" option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38215
diff
changeset
|
2074 ``time-track`` |
15a1e37f80bd
profiling: introduce a "profiling.time-track" option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38215
diff
changeset
|
2075 Control if the stat profiler track ``cpu`` or ``real`` time. |
40419
5e917b224c20
help: update the default value specified for `profiling.time-track`
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
40299
diff
changeset
|
2076 (default: ``cpu`` on Windows, otherwise ``real``) |
38260
15a1e37f80bd
profiling: introduce a "profiling.time-track" option
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38215
diff
changeset
|
2077 |
18548
e71c2ff93167
profiling: introduce limit configuration option
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18502
diff
changeset
|
2078 ``limit`` |
e71c2ff93167
profiling: introduce limit configuration option
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18502
diff
changeset
|
2079 Number of lines to show. Specific to the ``ls`` instrumenting profiler. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2080 (default: 30) |
18548
e71c2ff93167
profiling: introduce limit configuration option
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18502
diff
changeset
|
2081 |
18502
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2082 ``nested`` |
18642
a40d608e2a7b
profiling: replace '+' markup of nested lines with indentation
Mads Kiilerich <mads@kiilerich.com>
parents:
18636
diff
changeset
|
2083 Show at most this number of lines of drill-down info after each main entry. |
a40d608e2a7b
profiling: replace '+' markup of nested lines with indentation
Mads Kiilerich <mads@kiilerich.com>
parents:
18636
diff
changeset
|
2084 This can help explain the difference between Total and Inline. |
18502
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2085 Specific to the ``ls`` instrumenting profiler. |
36696
0c431d3129c4
docs: small fixes for profiling.nested and the overall description
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35907
diff
changeset
|
2086 (default: 0) |
18502
68eecbaf1bd3
profiling: add documentation of lsprof 'sort' and 'nested'
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18385
diff
changeset
|
2087 |
32850
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2088 ``showmin`` |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2089 Minimum fraction of samples an entry must have for it to be displayed. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2090 Can be specified as a float between ``0.0`` and ``1.0`` or can have a |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2091 ``%`` afterwards to allow values up to ``100``. e.g. ``5%``. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2092 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2093 Only used by the ``stat`` profiler. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2094 |
32851
cb6436e051ca
profiling: allow configuring minimum display threshold for hotpath
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32850
diff
changeset
|
2095 For the ``hotpath`` format, default is ``0.05``. |
32850
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2096 For the ``chrome`` format, default is ``0.005``. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2097 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2098 The option is unused on other formats. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2099 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2100 ``showmax`` |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2101 Maximum fraction of samples an entry can have before it is ignored in |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2102 display. Values format is the same as ``showmin``. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2103 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2104 Only used by the ``stat`` profiler. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2105 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2106 For the ``chrome`` format, default is ``0.999``. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2107 |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2108 The option is unused on other formats. |
e33c9a47b0db
config: document profiling.show{min,max}
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32744
diff
changeset
|
2109 |
42423
0ae593e791fb
profiling: show actual time spent in hotpath display
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
42325
diff
changeset
|
2110 ``showtime`` |
0ae593e791fb
profiling: show actual time spent in hotpath display
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
42325
diff
changeset
|
2111 Show time taken as absolute durations, in addition to percentages. |
0ae593e791fb
profiling: show actual time spent in hotpath display
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
42325
diff
changeset
|
2112 Only used by the ``hotpath`` format. |
0ae593e791fb
profiling: show actual time spent in hotpath display
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
42325
diff
changeset
|
2113 (default: true) |
0ae593e791fb
profiling: show actual time spent in hotpath display
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
42325
diff
changeset
|
2114 |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2115 ``progress`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2116 ------------ |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2117 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2118 Mercurial commands can draw progress bars that are as informative as |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2119 possible. Some progress bars only offer indeterminate information, while others |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2120 have a definite end point. |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2121 |
41137
785a75f0ddcb
progress: document progress.debug config option
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
2122 ``debug`` |
785a75f0ddcb
progress: document progress.debug config option
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
2123 Whether to print debug info when updating the progress bar. (default: False) |
785a75f0ddcb
progress: document progress.debug config option
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
2124 |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2125 ``delay`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2126 Number of seconds (float) before showing the progress bar. (default: 3) |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2127 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2128 ``changedelay`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2129 Minimum delay before showing a new topic. When set to less than 3 * refresh, |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2130 that value will be used instead. (default: 1) |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2131 |
34314
a667f0ca1d5f
progress: make ETA only consider progress made in the last minute
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
34146
diff
changeset
|
2132 ``estimateinterval`` |
a667f0ca1d5f
progress: make ETA only consider progress made in the last minute
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
34146
diff
changeset
|
2133 Maximum sampling interval in seconds for speed and estimated time |
a667f0ca1d5f
progress: make ETA only consider progress made in the last minute
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
34146
diff
changeset
|
2134 calculation. (default: 60) |
a667f0ca1d5f
progress: make ETA only consider progress made in the last minute
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
34146
diff
changeset
|
2135 |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2136 ``refresh`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2137 Time in seconds between refreshes of the progress bar. (default: 0.1) |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2138 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2139 ``format`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2140 Format of the progress bar. |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2141 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2142 Valid entries for the format field are ``topic``, ``bar``, ``number``, |
27665
72a25271e294
help: use backticks for progress.format keywords, correct letter case
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
27657
diff
changeset
|
2143 ``unit``, ``estimate``, ``speed``, and ``item``. ``item`` defaults to the |
72a25271e294
help: use backticks for progress.format keywords, correct letter case
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
27657
diff
changeset
|
2144 last 20 characters of the item, but this can be changed by adding either |
72a25271e294
help: use backticks for progress.format keywords, correct letter case
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
27657
diff
changeset
|
2145 ``-<num>`` which would take the last num characters, or ``+<num>`` for the |
72a25271e294
help: use backticks for progress.format keywords, correct letter case
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
27657
diff
changeset
|
2146 first num characters. |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2147 |
27665
72a25271e294
help: use backticks for progress.format keywords, correct letter case
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
27657
diff
changeset
|
2148 (default: topic bar number estimate) |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2149 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2150 ``width`` |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2151 If set, the maximum width of the progress information (that is, min(width, |
26177 | 2152 term width) will be used). |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2153 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2154 ``clear-complete`` |
26278 | 2155 Clear the progress bar after it's done. (default: True) |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2156 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2157 ``disable`` |
26177 | 2158 If true, don't show a progress bar. |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2159 |
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2160 ``assume-tty`` |
26177 | 2161 If true, ALWAYS show a progress bar, unless disable is given. |
25520
c8fada8d9db9
progress: move config help into core config help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
25430
diff
changeset
|
2162 |
27746
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2163 ``rebase`` |
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2164 ---------- |
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2165 |
34872
29f52e7966dd
config: gather allowdivergence under the evolution namespace
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
34796
diff
changeset
|
2166 ``evolution.allowdivergence`` |
27746
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2167 Default to False, when True allow creating divergence when performing |
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2168 rebase of obsolete changesets. |
f0e9f38d250f
rebase: prevent creating divergence
Laurent Charignon <lcharignon@fb.com>
parents:
27742
diff
changeset
|
2169 |
14691
b1efd75cdafe
help/config: mention [revsetalias] section
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14661
diff
changeset
|
2170 ``revsetalias`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2171 --------------- |
14691
b1efd75cdafe
help/config: mention [revsetalias] section
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14661
diff
changeset
|
2172 |
b1efd75cdafe
help/config: mention [revsetalias] section
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14661
diff
changeset
|
2173 Alias definitions for revsets. See :hg:`help revsets` for details. |
b1efd75cdafe
help/config: mention [revsetalias] section
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14661
diff
changeset
|
2174 |
41120
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2175 ``rewrite`` |
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2176 ----------- |
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2177 |
41207
25cec00b333c
help: document rewrite.backup-bundle option
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
41137
diff
changeset
|
2178 ``backup-bundle`` |
25cec00b333c
help: document rewrite.backup-bundle option
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
41137
diff
changeset
|
2179 Whether to save stripped changesets to a bundle file. (default: True) |
25cec00b333c
help: document rewrite.backup-bundle option
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
41137
diff
changeset
|
2180 |
41120
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2181 ``update-timestamp`` |
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2182 If true, updates the date and time of the changeset to current. It is only |
42932
e4803231f538
amend: add option to update to the current user
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
42516
diff
changeset
|
2183 applicable for `hg amend`, `hg commit --amend` and `hg uncommit` in the |
e4803231f538
amend: add option to update to the current user
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
42516
diff
changeset
|
2184 current version. |
41120
79f8f032c706
amend: add config option to update time to current in hg amend (issue5828)
Taapas Agrawal <taapas2897@gmail.com>
parents:
41106
diff
changeset
|
2185 |
45121
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2186 ``empty-successor`` |
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2187 |
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2188 Control what happens with empty successors that are the result of rewrite |
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2189 operations. If set to ``skip``, the successor is not created. If set to |
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2190 ``keep``, the empty successor is created and kept. |
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2191 |
45124
3ee8e2d5c0d8
absorb: consider rewrite.empty-successor configuration
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45123
diff
changeset
|
2192 Currently, only the rebase and absorb commands consider this configuration. |
45123
1efbfa9b36a7
rebase: consider rewrite.empty-successor configuration
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45121
diff
changeset
|
2193 (EXPERIMENTAL) |
45121
b6269741ed42
config: add option to control creation of empty successors during rewrite
Manuel Jacob <me@manueljacob.de>
parents:
45058
diff
changeset
|
2194 |
49564
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2195 ``rhg`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2196 ------- |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2197 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2198 The pure Rust fast-path for Mercurial. See `rust/README.rst` in the Mercurial repository. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2199 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2200 ``fallback-executable`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2201 Path to the executable to run in a sub-process when falling back to |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2202 another implementation of Mercurial. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2203 |
49569
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2204 ``fallback-immediately`` |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2205 Fall back to ``fallback-executable`` as soon as possible, regardless of |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2206 the `rhg.on-unsupported` configuration. Useful for debugging, for example to |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2207 bypass `rhg` if the deault `hg` points to `rhg`. |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2208 |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2209 Note that because this requires loading the configuration, it is possible |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2210 that `rhg` error out before being able to fall back. |
5318ac25dfdc
rhg: add a config option to fall back immediately
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49564
diff
changeset
|
2211 |
49564
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2212 ``ignored-extensions`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2213 Controls which extensions should be ignored by `rhg`. By default, `rhg` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2214 triggers the `rhg.on-unsupported` behavior any unsupported extensions. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2215 Users can disable that behavior when they know that a given extension |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2216 does not need support from `rhg`. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2217 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2218 Expects a list of extension names, or ``*`` to ignore all extensions. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2219 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2220 Note: ``*:<suboption>`` is also a valid extension name for this |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2221 configuration option. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2222 As of this writing, the only valid "global" suboption is ``required``. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2223 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2224 ``on-unsupported`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2225 Controls the behavior of `rhg` when detecting unsupported features. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2226 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2227 Possible values are `abort` (default), `abort-silent` and `fallback`. |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2228 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2229 ``abort`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2230 Print an error message describing what feature is not supported, |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2231 and exit with code 252 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2232 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2233 ``abort-silent`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2234 Silently exit with code 252 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2235 |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2236 ``fallback`` |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2237 Try running the fallback executable with the same parameters |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2238 (and trace the fallback reason, use `RUST_LOG=trace` to see). |
b1c20e41098f
rhg: add `config.rhg` helptext
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49563
diff
changeset
|
2239 |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2240 ``share`` |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2241 --------- |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2242 |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2243 ``safe-mismatch.source-safe`` |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2244 Controls what happens when the shared repository does not use the |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2245 share-safe mechanism but its source repository does. |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2246 |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2247 Possible values are `abort` (default), `allow`, `upgrade-abort` and |
48726
b6a0c1015ee2
help: avoid repeated value in the safe-mistmatch help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48725
diff
changeset
|
2248 `upgrade-allow`. |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2249 |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2250 ``abort`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2251 Disallows running any command and aborts |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2252 ``allow`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2253 Respects the feature presence in the share source |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2254 ``upgrade-abort`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2255 Tries to upgrade the share to use share-safe; if it fails, aborts |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2256 ``upgrade-allow`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2257 Tries to upgrade the share; if it fails, continue by |
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2258 respecting the share source setting |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2259 |
48725
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
2260 Check :hg:`help config.format.use-share-safe` for details about the |
46347
5249ac2bc7a4
doc: point to the main share-safe doc in the "mismatch" config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46346
diff
changeset
|
2261 share-safe feature. |
5249ac2bc7a4
doc: point to the main share-safe doc in the "mismatch" config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46346
diff
changeset
|
2262 |
49343
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2263 ``safe-mismatch.source-safe:verbose-upgrade`` |
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2264 Display a message when upgrading, (default: True) |
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2265 |
46344
6bb52cc08855
doc: relocate doc for `share.safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46337
diff
changeset
|
2266 ``safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`` |
6bb52cc08855
doc: relocate doc for `share.safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46337
diff
changeset
|
2267 Shows a warning on operations if the shared repository does not use |
6bb52cc08855
doc: relocate doc for `share.safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46337
diff
changeset
|
2268 share-safe, but the source repository does. |
6bb52cc08855
doc: relocate doc for `share.safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46337
diff
changeset
|
2269 (default: True) |
6bb52cc08855
doc: relocate doc for `share.safe-mismatch.source-safe.warn`
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46337
diff
changeset
|
2270 |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2271 ``safe-mismatch.source-not-safe`` |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2272 Controls what happens when the shared repository uses the share-safe |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2273 mechanism but its source does not. |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2274 |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2275 Possible values are `abort` (default), `allow`, `downgrade-abort` and |
48726
b6a0c1015ee2
help: avoid repeated value in the safe-mistmatch help
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48725
diff
changeset
|
2276 `downgrade-allow`. |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2277 |
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2278 ``abort`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2279 Disallows running any command and aborts |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2280 ``allow`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2281 Respects the feature presence in the share source |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2282 ``downgrade-abort`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2283 Tries to downgrade the share to not use share-safe; if it fails, aborts |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2284 ``downgrade-allow`` |
49563
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2285 Tries to downgrade the share to not use share-safe; |
9dce3960735b
config: fix indentation of some`share-safe` options
Raphaël Gomès <rgomes@octobus.net>
parents:
49343
diff
changeset
|
2286 if it fails, continue by respecting the shared source setting |
46335
25be21ec6c65
share: rework config options to be much clearer and easier
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46311
diff
changeset
|
2287 |
48725
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
2288 Check :hg:`help config.format.use-share-safe` for details about the |
46347
5249ac2bc7a4
doc: point to the main share-safe doc in the "mismatch" config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46346
diff
changeset
|
2289 share-safe feature. |
5249ac2bc7a4
doc: point to the main share-safe doc in the "mismatch" config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46346
diff
changeset
|
2290 |
49343
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2291 ``safe-mismatch.source-not-safe:verbose-upgrade`` |
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2292 Display a message when upgrading, (default: True) |
4f04bb0d8deb
auto-upgrade: add an option to silence the safe-mismatch message
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49342
diff
changeset
|
2293 |
46336
4f17773fc6b5
share: rename share-safe warning config
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46335
diff
changeset
|
2294 ``safe-mismatch.source-not-safe.warn`` |
4f17773fc6b5
share: rename share-safe warning config
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46335
diff
changeset
|
2295 Shows a warning on operations if the shared repository uses share-safe, |
4f17773fc6b5
share: rename share-safe warning config
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46335
diff
changeset
|
2296 but the source repository does not. |
4f17773fc6b5
share: rename share-safe warning config
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46335
diff
changeset
|
2297 (default: True) |
4f17773fc6b5
share: rename share-safe warning config
Pulkit Goyal <7895pulkit@gmail.com>
parents:
46335
diff
changeset
|
2298 |
38744
ae17555ef93f
config: rename `revlog` section into `storage`
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38737
diff
changeset
|
2299 ``storage`` |
38754
8b5f97ab5774
doc: fix underline length for config title (issue5949)
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38744
diff
changeset
|
2300 ----------- |
38737
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2301 |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2302 Control the strategy Mercurial uses internally to store history. Options in this |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2303 category impact performance and repository size. |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2304 |
47822
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2305 ``revlog.issue6528.fix-incoming`` |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2306 Version 5.8 of Mercurial had a bug leading to altering the parent of file |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2307 revision with copy information (or any other metadata) on exchange. This |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2308 leads to the copy metadata to be overlooked by various internal logic. The |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2309 issue was fixed in Mercurial 5.8.1. |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2310 (See https://bz.mercurial-scm.org/show_bug.cgi?id=6528 for details) |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2311 |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2312 As a result Mercurial is now checking and fixing incoming file revisions to |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2313 make sure there parents are in the right order. This behavior can be |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2314 disabled by setting this option to `no`. This apply to revisions added |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2315 through push, pull, clone and unbundle. |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2316 |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2317 To fix affected revisions that already exist within the repository, one can |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2318 use :hg:`debug-repair-issue-6528`. |
2813d406b036
issue6528: add a config option to control the fixing on the fly
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
47777
diff
changeset
|
2319 |
49657
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2320 .. container:: verbose |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2321 |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2322 ``revlog.delta-parent-search.candidate-group-chunk-size`` |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2323 Tune the number of delta bases the storage will consider in the |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2324 same "round" of search. In some very rare cases, using a smaller value |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2325 might result in faster processing at the possible expense of storage |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2326 space, while using larger values might result in slower processing at the |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2327 possible benefit of storage space. A value of "0" means no limitation. |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2328 |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2329 default: no limitation |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2330 |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2331 This is unlikely that you'll have to tune this configuration. If you think |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2332 you do, consider talking with the mercurial developer community about your |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2333 repositories. |
f5f113f1b011
delta-find: add a way to control the number of bases tested at the same time
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49569
diff
changeset
|
2334 |
38744
ae17555ef93f
config: rename `revlog` section into `storage`
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38737
diff
changeset
|
2335 ``revlog.optimize-delta-parent-choice`` |
38737
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2336 When storing a merge revision, both parents will be equally considered as |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2337 a possible delta base. This results in better delta selection and improved |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2338 revlog compression. This option is enabled by default. |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2339 |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2340 Turning this option off can result in large increase of repository size for |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2341 repository with many merges. |
913ca175c4ae
aggressivemergedelta: document rename and move to `revlog` section
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
38735
diff
changeset
|
2342 |
46307
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2343 ``revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap`` |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2344 Whether to use the Operating System "memory mapping" feature (when |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2345 possible) to access the persistent nodemap data. This improve performance |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2346 and reduce memory pressure. |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2347 |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2348 Default to True. |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2349 |
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2350 For details on the "persistent-nodemap" feature, see: |
48725
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
2351 :hg:`help config.format.use-persistent-nodemap`. |
46307
51da7c8ef357
persistent-nodemap: document storage.revlog.persistent-nodemap.mmap=no
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46305
diff
changeset
|
2352 |
46308
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2353 ``revlog.persistent-nodemap.slow-path`` |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2354 Control the behavior of Merucrial when using a repository with "persistent" |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2355 nodemap with an installation of Mercurial without a fast implementation for |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2356 the feature: |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2357 |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2358 ``allow``: Silently use the slower implementation to access the repository. |
46310
fc2d5c0aed7f
persistent-nodemap: add a "warn" option to the slow-path config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46308
diff
changeset
|
2359 ``warn``: Warn, but use the slower implementation to access the repository. |
46311
014ac7a32048
persistent-nodemap: add a "abort" option to the slow-path config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46310
diff
changeset
|
2360 ``abort``: Prevent access to such repositories. (This is the default) |
46308
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2361 |
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2362 For details on the "persistent-nodemap" feature, see: |
48725
4344fd2687dc
help: add missing `.` in config reference
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48674
diff
changeset
|
2363 :hg:`help config.format.use-persistent-nodemap`. |
46308
05a1e44b2224
persistent-nodemap: add a revlog.storage.persistent-nodemap.slow-path option
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
46307
diff
changeset
|
2364 |
41818
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2365 ``revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent`` |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2366 Control the order in which delta parents are considered when adding new |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2367 revisions from an external source. |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2368 (typically: apply bundle from `hg pull` or `hg push`). |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2369 |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2370 New revisions are usually provided as a delta against other revisions. By |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2371 default, Mercurial will try to reuse this delta first, therefore using the |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2372 same "delta parent" as the source. Directly using delta's from the source |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2373 reduces CPU usage and usually speeds up operation. However, in some case, |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2374 the source might have sub-optimal delta bases and forcing their reevaluation |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2375 is useful. For example, pushes from an old client could have sub-optimal |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2376 delta's parent that the server want to optimize. (lack of general delta, bad |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2377 parents, choice, lack of sparse-revlog, etc). |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2378 |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2379 This option is enabled by default. Turning it off will ensure bad delta |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2380 parent choices from older client do not propagate to this repository, at |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2381 the cost of a small increase in CPU consumption. |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2382 |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2383 Note: this option only control the order in which delta parents are |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2384 considered. Even when disabled, the existing delta from the source will be |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2385 reused if the same delta parent is selected. |
f6eff9e4de80
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41529
diff
changeset
|
2386 |
41819
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2387 ``revlog.reuse-external-delta`` |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2388 Control the reuse of delta from external source. |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2389 (typically: apply bundle from `hg pull` or `hg push`). |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2390 |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2391 New revisions are usually provided as a delta against another revision. By |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2392 default, Mercurial will not recompute the same delta again, trusting |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2393 externally provided deltas. There have been rare cases of small adjustment |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2394 to the diffing algorithm in the past. So in some rare case, recomputing |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2395 delta provided by ancient clients can provides better results. Disabling |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2396 this option means going through a full delta recomputation for all incoming |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2397 revisions. It means a large increase in CPU usage and will slow operations |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2398 down. |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2399 |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2400 This option is enabled by default. When disabled, it also disables the |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2401 related ``storage.revlog.reuse-external-delta-parent`` option. |
688fc33e105d
storage: introduce a `revlog.reuse-external-delta` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41818
diff
changeset
|
2402 |
42043
1fac9b931d46
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zlib.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41840
diff
changeset
|
2403 ``revlog.zlib.level`` |
1fac9b931d46
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zlib.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41840
diff
changeset
|
2404 Zlib compression level used when storing data into the repository. Accepted |
1fac9b931d46
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zlib.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41840
diff
changeset
|
2405 Value range from 1 (lowest compression) to 9 (highest compression). Zlib |
1fac9b931d46
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zlib.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41840
diff
changeset
|
2406 default value is 6. |
1fac9b931d46
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zlib.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
41840
diff
changeset
|
2407 |
42044
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2408 |
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2409 ``revlog.zstd.level`` |
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2410 zstd compression level used when storing data into the repository. Accepted |
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2411 Value range from 1 (lowest compression) to 22 (highest compression). |
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2412 (default 3) |
bb271ec2fbfb
compression: introduce a `storage.revlog.zstd.level` configuration
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42043
diff
changeset
|
2413 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2414 ``server`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2415 ---------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2416 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2417 Controls generic server settings. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2418 |
35261
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2419 ``bookmarks-pushkey-compat`` |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2420 Trigger pushkey hook when being pushed bookmark updates. This config exist |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2421 for compatibility purpose (default to True) |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2422 |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2423 If you use ``pushkey`` and ``pre-pushkey`` hooks to control bookmark |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2424 movement we recommend you migrate them to ``txnclose-bookmark`` and |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2425 ``pretxnclose-bookmark``. |
f392066d127c
bookmark: add pushkey hook compatiblity to the bundle2 part
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35209
diff
changeset
|
2426 |
30762
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2427 ``compressionengines`` |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2428 List of compression engines and their relative priority to advertise |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2429 to clients. |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2430 |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2431 The order of compression engines determines their priority, the first |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2432 having the highest priority. If a compression engine is not listed |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2433 here, it won't be advertised to clients. |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2434 |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2435 If not set (the default), built-in defaults are used. Run |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2436 :hg:`debuginstall` to list available compression engines and their |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2437 default wire protocol priority. |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2438 |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2439 Older Mercurial clients only support zlib compression and this setting |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2440 has no effect for legacy clients. |
35b516f800e0
wireproto: advertise supported media types and compression formats
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30704
diff
changeset
|
2441 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2442 ``uncompressed`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2443 Whether to allow clients to clone a repository using the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2444 uncompressed streaming protocol. This transfers about 40% more |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2445 data than a regular clone, but uses less memory and CPU on both |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2446 server and client. Over a LAN (100 Mbps or better) or a very fast |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2447 WAN, an uncompressed streaming clone is a lot faster (~10x) than a |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2448 regular clone. Over most WAN connections (anything slower than |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2449 about 6 Mbps), uncompressed streaming is slower, because of the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2450 extra data transfer overhead. This mode will also temporarily hold |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2451 the write lock while determining what data to transfer. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2452 (default: True) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2453 |
32744
33b7283a3828
streamclone: consider secret changesets (BC) (issue5589)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32666
diff
changeset
|
2454 ``uncompressedallowsecret`` |
33b7283a3828
streamclone: consider secret changesets (BC) (issue5589)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32666
diff
changeset
|
2455 Whether to allow stream clones when the repository contains secret |
33b7283a3828
streamclone: consider secret changesets (BC) (issue5589)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32666
diff
changeset
|
2456 changesets. (default: False) |
33b7283a3828
streamclone: consider secret changesets (BC) (issue5589)
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
32666
diff
changeset
|
2457 |
16361
6097ede2be4d
protocol: Add the stream-preferred capability
Benoit Allard <benoit@aeteurope.nl>
parents:
16140
diff
changeset
|
2458 ``preferuncompressed`` |
6097ede2be4d
protocol: Add the stream-preferred capability
Benoit Allard <benoit@aeteurope.nl>
parents:
16140
diff
changeset
|
2459 When set, clients will try to use the uncompressed streaming |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2460 protocol. (default: False) |
16361
6097ede2be4d
protocol: Add the stream-preferred capability
Benoit Allard <benoit@aeteurope.nl>
parents:
16140
diff
changeset
|
2461 |
32260
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2462 ``disablefullbundle`` |
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2463 When set, servers will refuse attempts to do pull-based clones. |
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2464 If this option is set, ``preferuncompressed`` and/or clone bundles |
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2465 are highly recommended. Partial clones will still be allowed. |
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2466 (default: False) |
d0d9a4fca59b
clone: add a server-side option to disable full getbundles (pull-based clones)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
32139
diff
changeset
|
2467 |
37414
2d965bfeb8f6
wireproto: allow direct stream processing for unbundle
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37009
diff
changeset
|
2468 ``streamunbundle`` |
2d965bfeb8f6
wireproto: allow direct stream processing for unbundle
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37009
diff
changeset
|
2469 When set, servers will apply data sent from the client directly, |
2d965bfeb8f6
wireproto: allow direct stream processing for unbundle
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37009
diff
changeset
|
2470 otherwise it will be written to a temporary file first. This option |
2d965bfeb8f6
wireproto: allow direct stream processing for unbundle
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37009
diff
changeset
|
2471 effectively prevents concurrent pushes. |
2d965bfeb8f6
wireproto: allow direct stream processing for unbundle
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37009
diff
changeset
|
2472 |
37498
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2473 ``pullbundle`` |
48980
6e7ae547e38d
pullbundle: fix file name in the help text
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
48793
diff
changeset
|
2474 When set, the server will check pullbundles.manifest for bundles |
37498
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2475 covering the requested heads and common nodes. The first matching |
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2476 entry will be streamed to the client. |
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2477 |
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2478 For HTTP transport, the stream will still use zlib compression |
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2479 for older clients. |
aacfca6f9767
wireproto: support for pullbundles
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
37414
diff
changeset
|
2480 |
32892
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2481 ``concurrent-push-mode`` |
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2482 Level of allowed race condition between two pushing clients. |
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2483 |
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2484 - 'strict': push is abort if another client touched the repository |
44412
edc8504bc26b
exchange: turn on option that makes concurrent pushes work better
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
44410
diff
changeset
|
2485 while the push was preparing. |
32892
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2486 - 'check-related': push is only aborted if it affects head that got also |
44412
edc8504bc26b
exchange: turn on option that makes concurrent pushes work better
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
44410
diff
changeset
|
2487 affected while the push was preparing. (default since 5.4) |
32892
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2488 |
44410
c85d5fd1a5d9
help: clarify behavior of server.concurrent-push-mode
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
44382
diff
changeset
|
2489 'check-related' only takes effect for compatible clients (version |
c85d5fd1a5d9
help: clarify behavior of server.concurrent-push-mode
Valentin Gatien-Baron <valentin.gatienbaron@gmail.com>
parents:
44382
diff
changeset
|
2490 4.3 and later). Older clients will use 'strict'. |
32892
a7851519ea02
check-concurrency: expose the feature as 'concurrent-push-mode'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
32872
diff
changeset
|
2491 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2492 ``validate`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2493 Whether to validate the completeness of pushed changesets by |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2494 checking that all new file revisions specified in manifests are |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2495 present. (default: False) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2496 |
25691
5cda0ce05c42
wireproto: add config knob for http header length limit
Mike Edgar <adgar@google.com>
parents:
25649
diff
changeset
|
2497 ``maxhttpheaderlen`` |
5cda0ce05c42
wireproto: add config knob for http header length limit
Mike Edgar <adgar@google.com>
parents:
25649
diff
changeset
|
2498 Instruct HTTP clients not to send request headers longer than this |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2499 many bytes. (default: 1024) |
25691
5cda0ce05c42
wireproto: add config knob for http header length limit
Mike Edgar <adgar@google.com>
parents:
25649
diff
changeset
|
2500 |
27246
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2501 ``bundle1`` |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2502 Whether to allow clients to push and pull using the legacy bundle1 |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2503 exchange format. (default: True) |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2504 |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2505 ``bundle1gd`` |
27683
76fc5ac23473
help: fix quoting for bundle1 options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27665
diff
changeset
|
2506 Like ``bundle1`` but only used if the repository is using the |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2507 *generaldelta* storage format. (default: True) |
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2508 |
27246
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2509 ``bundle1.push`` |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2510 Whether to allow clients to push using the legacy bundle1 exchange |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2511 format. (default: True) |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2512 |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2513 ``bundle1gd.push`` |
27683
76fc5ac23473
help: fix quoting for bundle1 options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27665
diff
changeset
|
2514 Like ``bundle1.push`` but only used if the repository is using the |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2515 *generaldelta* storage format. (default: True) |
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2516 |
27246
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2517 ``bundle1.pull`` |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2518 Whether to allow clients to pull using the legacy bundle1 exchange |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2519 format. (default: True) |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2520 |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2521 ``bundle1gd.pull`` |
27683
76fc5ac23473
help: fix quoting for bundle1 options
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27665
diff
changeset
|
2522 Like ``bundle1.pull`` but only used if the repository is using the |
27633
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2523 *generaldelta* storage format. (default: True) |
37d7cf569cf3
wireproto: support disabling bundle1 only if repo is generaldelta
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27607
diff
changeset
|
2524 |
27246
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2525 Large repositories using the *generaldelta* storage format should |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2526 consider setting this option because converting *generaldelta* |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2527 repositories to the exchange format required by the bundle1 data |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2528 format can consume a lot of CPU. |
b288fb2724bf
wireproto: config options to disable bundle1
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27216
diff
changeset
|
2529 |
39721
1b5880352314
bundle2: graduate bundle2.stream option from experimental to server section
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
39441
diff
changeset
|
2530 ``bundle2.stream`` |
1b5880352314
bundle2: graduate bundle2.stream option from experimental to server section
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
39441
diff
changeset
|
2531 Whether to allow clients to pull using the bundle2 streaming protocol. |
39722
4bd6e444c76f
bundle2: make server.bundle2.stream default to True
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
39721
diff
changeset
|
2532 (default: True) |
39721
1b5880352314
bundle2: graduate bundle2.stream option from experimental to server section
Anton Shestakov <av6@dwimlabs.net>
parents:
39441
diff
changeset
|
2533 |
29748
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2534 ``zliblevel`` |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2535 Integer between ``-1`` and ``9`` that controls the zlib compression level |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2536 for wire protocol commands that send zlib compressed output (notably the |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2537 commands that send repository history data). |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2538 |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2539 The default (``-1``) uses the default zlib compression level, which is |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2540 likely equivalent to ``6``. ``0`` means no compression. ``9`` means |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2541 maximum compression. |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2542 |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2543 Setting this option allows server operators to make trade-offs between |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2544 bandwidth and CPU used. Lowering the compression lowers CPU utilization |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2545 but sends more bytes to clients. |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2546 |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2547 This option only impacts the HTTP server. |
5e2365698d44
hgweb: config option to control zlib compression level
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2548 |
30764
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2549 ``zstdlevel`` |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2550 Integer between ``1`` and ``22`` that controls the zstd compression level |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2551 for wire protocol commands. ``1`` is the minimal amount of compression and |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2552 ``22`` is the highest amount of compression. |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2553 |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2554 The default (``3``) should be significantly faster than zlib while likely |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2555 delivering better compression ratios. |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2556 |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2557 This option only impacts the HTTP server. |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2558 |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2559 See also ``server.zliblevel``. |
e75463e3179f
protocol: send application/mercurial-0.2 responses to capable clients
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30762
diff
changeset
|
2560 |
41840
d6569f1e9b37
server: allow customizing the default repo filter
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
41819
diff
changeset
|
2561 ``view`` |
d6569f1e9b37
server: allow customizing the default repo filter
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
41819
diff
changeset
|
2562 Repository filter used when exchanging revisions with the peer. |
d6569f1e9b37
server: allow customizing the default repo filter
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
41819
diff
changeset
|
2563 |
d6569f1e9b37
server: allow customizing the default repo filter
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
41819
diff
changeset
|
2564 The default view (``served``) excludes secret and hidden changesets. |
42139
08481e11462e
repoview: flag `server.view` as experimental
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42046
diff
changeset
|
2565 Another useful value is ``immutable`` (no draft, secret or hidden |
08481e11462e
repoview: flag `server.view` as experimental
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
42046
diff
changeset
|
2566 changesets). (EXPERIMENTAL) |
41840
d6569f1e9b37
server: allow customizing the default repo filter
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
41819
diff
changeset
|
2567 |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2568 ``smtp`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2569 -------- |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2570 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2571 Configuration for extensions that need to send email messages. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2572 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2573 ``host`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2574 Host name of mail server, e.g. "mail.example.com". |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2575 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2576 ``port`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2577 Optional. Port to connect to on mail server. (default: 465 if |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2578 ``tls`` is smtps; 25 otherwise) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2579 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2580 ``tls`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2581 Optional. Method to enable TLS when connecting to mail server: starttls, |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2582 smtps or none. (default: none) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2583 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2584 ``username`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2585 Optional. User name for authenticating with the SMTP server. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2586 (default: None) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2587 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2588 ``password`` |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2589 Optional. Password for authenticating with the SMTP server. If not |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2590 specified, interactive sessions will prompt the user for a |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2591 password; non-interactive sessions will fail. (default: None) |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2592 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2593 ``local_hostname`` |
26180
b1caa076fc3b
help/config: change local_hostname help style
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26179
diff
changeset
|
2594 Optional. The hostname that the sender can use to identify |
16140
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2595 itself to the MTA. |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2596 |
dbf64594a3c3
help: sort hgrc related "Sections" chapters alphabetically
Michal Sznajder <michalsznajder@gmail.com>
parents:
16139
diff
changeset
|
2597 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2598 ``subpaths`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2599 ------------ |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2600 |
16549
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2601 Subrepository source URLs can go stale if a remote server changes name |
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2602 or becomes temporarily unavailable. This section lets you define |
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2603 rewrite rules of the form:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2604 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2605 <pattern> = <replacement> |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2606 |
16549
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2607 where ``pattern`` is a regular expression matching a subrepository |
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2608 source URL and ``replacement`` is the replacement string used to |
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2609 rewrite it. Groups can be matched in ``pattern`` and referenced in |
517b25608ad6
help/config: expand [subpaths] help
Martin Geisler <mg@aragost.com>
parents:
16513
diff
changeset
|
2610 ``replacements``. For instance:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2611 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2612 http://server/(.*)-hg/ = http://hg.server/\1/ |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2613 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2614 rewrites ``http://server/foo-hg/`` into ``http://hg.server/foo/``. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2615 |
17251
98166640b356
help: fix some instances of 'the the'
Mads Kiilerich <mads@kiilerich.com>
parents:
17202
diff
changeset
|
2616 Relative subrepository paths are first made absolute, and the |
29368
dd9175ca81dc
help: document that [subpaths] may rewrite relative paths
Mike Miller <mike@mtmxr.com>
parents:
28957
diff
changeset
|
2617 rewrite rules are then applied on the full (absolute) path. If ``pattern`` |
dd9175ca81dc
help: document that [subpaths] may rewrite relative paths
Mike Miller <mike@mtmxr.com>
parents:
28957
diff
changeset
|
2618 doesn't match the full path, an attempt is made to apply it on the |
dd9175ca81dc
help: document that [subpaths] may rewrite relative paths
Mike Miller <mike@mtmxr.com>
parents:
28957
diff
changeset
|
2619 relative path alone. The rules are applied in definition order. |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2620 |
34985
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2621 ``subrepos`` |
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2622 ------------ |
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2623 |
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2624 This section contains options that control the behavior of the |
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2625 subrepositories feature. See also :hg:`help subrepos`. |
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2626 |
34989
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2627 Security note: auditing in Mercurial is known to be insufficient to |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2628 prevent clone-time code execution with carefully constructed Git |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2629 subrepos. It is unknown if a similar detect is present in Subversion |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2630 subrepos. Both Git and Subversion subrepos are disabled by default |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2631 out of security concerns. These subrepo types can be enabled using |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2632 the respective options below. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2633 |
34985
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2634 ``allowed`` |
34989
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2635 Whether subrepositories are allowed in the working directory. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2636 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2637 When false, commands involving subrepositories (like :hg:`update`) |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2638 will fail for all subrepository types. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2639 (default: true) |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2640 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2641 ``hg:allowed`` |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2642 Whether Mercurial subrepositories are allowed in the working |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2643 directory. This option only has an effect if ``subrepos.allowed`` |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2644 is true. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2645 (default: true) |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2646 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2647 ``git:allowed`` |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2648 Whether Git subrepositories are allowed in the working directory. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2649 This option only has an effect if ``subrepos.allowed`` is true. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2650 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2651 See the security note above before enabling Git subrepos. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2652 (default: false) |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2653 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2654 ``svn:allowed`` |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2655 Whether Subversion subrepositories are allowed in the working |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2656 directory. This option only has an effect if ``subrepos.allowed`` |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2657 is true. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2658 |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2659 See the security note above before enabling Subversion subrepos. |
1a314176da9c
subrepo: use per-type config options to enable subrepos
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
34988
diff
changeset
|
2660 (default: false) |
34985
5e27afeddaee
subrepo: add config option to reject any subrepo operations (SEC)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
34931
diff
changeset
|
2661 |
28957
d813132ea361
templater: load and expand aliases by template engine (API) (issue4842)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
28846
diff
changeset
|
2662 ``templatealias`` |
d813132ea361
templater: load and expand aliases by template engine (API) (issue4842)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
28846
diff
changeset
|
2663 ----------------- |
d813132ea361
templater: load and expand aliases by template engine (API) (issue4842)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
28846
diff
changeset
|
2664 |
d813132ea361
templater: load and expand aliases by template engine (API) (issue4842)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
28846
diff
changeset
|
2665 Alias definitions for templates. See :hg:`help templates` for details. |
d813132ea361
templater: load and expand aliases by template engine (API) (issue4842)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
28846
diff
changeset
|
2666 |
29717
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2667 ``templates`` |
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2668 ------------- |
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2669 |
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2670 Use the ``[templates]`` section to define template strings. |
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2671 See :hg:`help templates` for details. |
a12d13eac513
help: add example of '[templates]' usage
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
29649
diff
changeset
|
2672 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2673 ``trusted`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2674 ----------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2675 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2676 Mercurial will not use the settings in the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2677 ``.hg/hgrc`` file from a repository if it doesn't belong to a trusted |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2678 user or to a trusted group, as various hgrc features allow arbitrary |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2679 commands to be run. This issue is often encountered when configuring |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2680 hooks or extensions for shared repositories or servers. However, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2681 the web interface will use some safe settings from the ``[web]`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2682 section. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2683 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2684 This section specifies what users and groups are trusted. The |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2685 current user is always trusted. To trust everybody, list a user or a |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2686 group with name ``*``. These settings must be placed in an |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2687 *already-trusted file* to take effect, such as ``$HOME/.hgrc`` of the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2688 user or service running Mercurial. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2689 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2690 ``users`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2691 Comma-separated list of trusted users. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2692 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2693 ``groups`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2694 Comma-separated list of trusted groups. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2695 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2696 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2697 ``ui`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
2698 ------ |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2699 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2700 User interface controls. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2701 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2702 ``archivemeta`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2703 Whether to include the .hg_archival.txt file containing meta data |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2704 (hashes for the repository base and for tip) in archives created |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2705 by the :hg:`archive` command or downloaded via hgweb. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2706 (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2707 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2708 ``askusername`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2709 Whether to prompt for a username when committing. If True, and |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2710 neither ``$HGUSER`` nor ``$EMAIL`` has been specified, then the user will |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2711 be prompted to enter a username. If no username is entered, the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2712 default ``USER@HOST`` is used instead. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2713 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2714 |
27738
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2715 ``clonebundles`` |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2716 Whether the "clone bundles" feature is enabled. |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2717 |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2718 When enabled, :hg:`clone` may download and apply a server-advertised |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2719 bundle file from a URL instead of using the normal exchange mechanism. |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2720 |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2721 This can likely result in faster and more reliable clones. |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2722 |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2723 (default: True) |
a0e783d26e81
exchange: make clone bundles non-experimental and enabled by default
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27737
diff
changeset
|
2724 |
26623
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2725 ``clonebundlefallback`` |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2726 Whether failure to apply an advertised "clone bundle" from a server |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2727 should result in fallback to a regular clone. |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2728 |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2729 This is disabled by default because servers advertising "clone |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2730 bundles" often do so to reduce server load. If advertised bundles |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2731 start mass failing and clients automatically fall back to a regular |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2732 clone, this would add significant and unexpected load to the server |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2733 since the server is expecting clone operations to be offloaded to |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2734 pre-generated bundles. Failing fast (the default behavior) ensures |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2735 clients don't overwhelm the server when "clone bundle" application |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2736 fails. |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2737 |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2738 (default: False) |
5a95fe44121d
clonebundles: support for seeding clones from pre-generated bundles
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
26421
diff
changeset
|
2739 |
27737
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2740 ``clonebundleprefers`` |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2741 Defines preferences for which "clone bundles" to use. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2742 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2743 Servers advertising "clone bundles" may advertise multiple available |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2744 bundles. Each bundle may have different attributes, such as the bundle |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2745 type and compression format. This option is used to prefer a particular |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2746 bundle over another. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2747 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2748 The following keys are defined by Mercurial: |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2749 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2750 BUNDLESPEC |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2751 A bundle type specifier. These are strings passed to :hg:`bundle -t`. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2752 e.g. ``gzip-v2`` or ``bzip2-v1``. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2753 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2754 COMPRESSION |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2755 The compression format of the bundle. e.g. ``gzip`` and ``bzip2``. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2756 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2757 Server operators may define custom keys. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2758 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2759 Example values: ``COMPRESSION=bzip2``, |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2760 ``BUNDLESPEC=gzip-v2, COMPRESSION=gzip``. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2761 |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2762 By default, the first bundle advertised by the server is used. |
482eb357fe98
exchange: make clonebundleprefers non-experimental
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27683
diff
changeset
|
2763 |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
2764 ``color`` |
32102
9a85ea1daf49
color: turn 'ui.color' into a boolean (auto or off)
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32101
diff
changeset
|
2765 When to colorize output. Possible value are Boolean ("yes" or "no"), or |
32103
9a98023ac8db
color: special case 'always' in 'ui.color'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32102
diff
changeset
|
2766 "debug", or "always". (default: "yes"). "yes" will use color whenever it |
9a98023ac8db
color: special case 'always' in 'ui.color'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32102
diff
changeset
|
2767 seems possible. See :hg:`help color` for details. |
31123
df0a0734304a
color: update main documentation
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
31001
diff
changeset
|
2768 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2769 ``commitsubrepos`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2770 Whether to commit modified subrepositories when committing the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2771 parent repository. If False and one subrepository has uncommitted |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2772 changes, abort the commit. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2773 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2774 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2775 ``debug`` |
26279 | 2776 Print debugging information. (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2777 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2778 ``editor`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2779 The editor to use during a commit. (default: ``$EDITOR`` or ``vi``) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2780 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2781 ``fallbackencoding`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2782 Encoding to try if it's not possible to decode the changelog using |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2783 UTF-8. (default: ISO-8859-1) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2784 |
27216
8117e2cd959e
graphlog: make node symbol templatable by ui.graphnodetemplate option
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
27093
diff
changeset
|
2785 ``graphnodetemplate`` |
45766
1f7c077e0640
config: rename ui.graphnodetemplate to command-templates.graphnode
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45765
diff
changeset
|
2786 (DEPRECATED) Use ``command-templates.graphnode`` instead. |
27216
8117e2cd959e
graphlog: make node symbol templatable by ui.graphnodetemplate option
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
27093
diff
changeset
|
2787 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2788 ``ignore`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2789 A file to read per-user ignore patterns from. This file should be |
23629
a04c7b74b3d5
ignore: resolve ignore files relative to repo root (issue4473) (BC)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23297
diff
changeset
|
2790 in the same format as a repository-wide .hgignore file. Filenames |
a04c7b74b3d5
ignore: resolve ignore files relative to repo root (issue4473) (BC)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23297
diff
changeset
|
2791 are relative to the repository root. This option supports hook syntax, |
a04c7b74b3d5
ignore: resolve ignore files relative to repo root (issue4473) (BC)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23297
diff
changeset
|
2792 so if you want to specify multiple ignore files, you can do so by |
a04c7b74b3d5
ignore: resolve ignore files relative to repo root (issue4473) (BC)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23297
diff
changeset
|
2793 setting something like ``ignore.other = ~/.hgignore2``. For details |
a04c7b74b3d5
ignore: resolve ignore files relative to repo root (issue4473) (BC)
Siddharth Agarwal <sid0@fb.com>
parents:
23297
diff
changeset
|
2794 of the ignore file format, see the ``hgignore(5)`` man page. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2795 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2796 ``interactive`` |
26279 | 2797 Allow to prompt the user. (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2798 |
28542
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2799 ``interface`` |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2800 Select the default interface for interactive features (default: text). |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2801 Possible values are 'text' and 'curses'. |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2802 |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2803 ``interface.chunkselector`` |
29648
94c5273c7d5d
doc: fix incorrect use of rst hg role in help text
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
29577
diff
changeset
|
2804 Select the interface for change recording (e.g. :hg:`commit -i`). |
28542
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2805 Possible values are 'text' and 'curses'. |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2806 This config overrides the interface specified by ui.interface. |
71e12fc53b80
ui: add new config flag for interface selection
Simon Farnsworth <simonfar@fb.com>
parents:
28525
diff
changeset
|
2807 |
38600
a936d1368fc5
ui: make the large file warning limit fully configurable
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
38591
diff
changeset
|
2808 ``large-file-limit`` |
a936d1368fc5
ui: make the large file warning limit fully configurable
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
38591
diff
changeset
|
2809 Largest file size that gives no memory use warning. |
a936d1368fc5
ui: make the large file warning limit fully configurable
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
38591
diff
changeset
|
2810 Possible values are integers or 0 to disable the check. |
49049
e31bba4c1be3
help: clarify the unit of `ui.large-file-limit` config
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
48980
diff
changeset
|
2811 Value is expressed in bytes by default, one can use standard units for |
49050
8653a2a33736
help: set the large-file-limit to 10MB
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@octobus.net>
parents:
49049
diff
changeset
|
2812 convenience (e.g. 10MB, 0.1GB, etc) (default: 10MB) |
38600
a936d1368fc5
ui: make the large file warning limit fully configurable
Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@bec.de>
parents:
38591
diff
changeset
|
2813 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2814 ``logtemplate`` |
45765
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2815 (DEPRECATED) Use ``command-templates.log`` instead. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2816 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2817 ``merge`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2818 The conflict resolution program to use during a manual merge. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2819 For more information on merge tools see :hg:`help merge-tools`. |
14654
e21fd445c297
help/config: quote config section names consistently
Wagner Bruna <wbruna@softwareexpress.com.br>
parents:
14653
diff
changeset
|
2820 For configuring merge tools see the ``[merge-tools]`` section. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2821 |
21519
25d5a9ecbb85
merge: add conflict marker formatter (BC)
Durham Goode <durham@fb.com>
parents:
21403
diff
changeset
|
2822 ``mergemarkers`` |
45767
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
2823 Sets the merge conflict marker label styling. The ``detailed`` style |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
2824 uses the ``command-templates.mergemarker`` setting to style the labels. |
21519
25d5a9ecbb85
merge: add conflict marker formatter (BC)
Durham Goode <durham@fb.com>
parents:
21403
diff
changeset
|
2825 The ``basic`` style just uses 'local' and 'other' as the marker label. |
25d5a9ecbb85
merge: add conflict marker formatter (BC)
Durham Goode <durham@fb.com>
parents:
21403
diff
changeset
|
2826 One of ``basic`` or ``detailed``. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2827 (default: ``basic``) |
21519
25d5a9ecbb85
merge: add conflict marker formatter (BC)
Durham Goode <durham@fb.com>
parents:
21403
diff
changeset
|
2828 |
25d5a9ecbb85
merge: add conflict marker formatter (BC)
Durham Goode <durham@fb.com>
parents:
21403
diff
changeset
|
2829 ``mergemarkertemplate`` |
45767
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
2830 (DEPRECATED) Use ``command-templates.mergemarker`` instead. |
35907
9037c29e9f53
filemerge: support passing labels to external merge tools
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
2831 |
40547
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2832 ``message-output`` |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2833 Where to write status and error messages. (default: ``stdio``) |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2834 |
45058
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
2835 ``channel`` |
f43bc4ce0d69
cmdserver: document message-encodings and channel output options
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
45057
diff
changeset
|
2836 Use separate channel for structured output. (Command-server only) |
40547
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2837 ``stderr`` |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2838 Everything to stderr. |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2839 ``stdio`` |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2840 Status to stdout, and error to stderr. |
840cd57cde32
ui: add config knob to redirect status messages to stderr (API)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
40478
diff
changeset
|
2841 |
26937
dda0aa3baedd
cmdutil: add origbackuppath helper
Christian Delahousse <cdelahousse@fb.com>
parents:
26907
diff
changeset
|
2842 ``origbackuppath`` |
dda0aa3baedd
cmdutil: add origbackuppath helper
Christian Delahousse <cdelahousse@fb.com>
parents:
26907
diff
changeset
|
2843 The path to a directory used to store generated .orig files. If the path is |
34146
9e4f82bc2b0b
scmutil: don't append .orig to backups in origbackuppath (BC)
Mark Thomas <mbthomas@fb.com>
parents:
34013
diff
changeset
|
2844 not a directory, one will be created. If set, files stored in this |
9e4f82bc2b0b
scmutil: don't append .orig to backups in origbackuppath (BC)
Mark Thomas <mbthomas@fb.com>
parents:
34013
diff
changeset
|
2845 directory have the same name as the original file and do not have a .orig |
9e4f82bc2b0b
scmutil: don't append .orig to backups in origbackuppath (BC)
Mark Thomas <mbthomas@fb.com>
parents:
34013
diff
changeset
|
2846 suffix. |
26937
dda0aa3baedd
cmdutil: add origbackuppath helper
Christian Delahousse <cdelahousse@fb.com>
parents:
26907
diff
changeset
|
2847 |
32104
f06d23af6cdf
pager: rename 'pager.enable' to 'ui.paginate'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32103
diff
changeset
|
2848 ``paginate`` |
f06d23af6cdf
pager: rename 'pager.enable' to 'ui.paginate'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32103
diff
changeset
|
2849 Control the pagination of command output (default: True). See :hg:`help pager` |
f06d23af6cdf
pager: rename 'pager.enable' to 'ui.paginate'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32103
diff
changeset
|
2850 for details. |
f06d23af6cdf
pager: rename 'pager.enable' to 'ui.paginate'
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@ens-lyon.org>
parents:
32103
diff
changeset
|
2851 |
25649
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2852 ``patch`` |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2853 An optional external tool that ``hg import`` and some extensions |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2854 will use for applying patches. By default Mercurial uses an |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2855 internal patch utility. The external tool must work as the common |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2856 Unix ``patch`` program. In particular, it must accept a ``-p`` |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2857 argument to strip patch headers, a ``-d`` argument to specify the |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2858 current directory, a file name to patch, and a patch file to take |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2859 from stdin. |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2860 |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2861 It is possible to specify a patch tool together with extra |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2862 arguments. For example, setting this option to ``patch --merge`` |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2863 will use the ``patch`` program with its 2-way merge option. |
e90e031b3016
doc: document the ui.patch option
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
25631
diff
changeset
|
2864 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2865 ``portablefilenames`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2866 Check for portable filenames. Can be ``warn``, ``ignore`` or ``abort``. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2867 (default: ``warn``) |
27758
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2868 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2869 ``warn`` |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2870 Print a warning message on POSIX platforms, if a file with a non-portable |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2871 filename is added (e.g. a file with a name that can't be created on |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2872 Windows because it contains reserved parts like ``AUX``, reserved |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2873 characters like ``:``, or would cause a case collision with an existing |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2874 file). |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2875 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2876 ``ignore`` |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2877 Don't print a warning. |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2878 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2879 ``abort`` |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2880 The command is aborted. |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2881 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2882 ``true`` |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2883 Alias for ``warn``. |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2884 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2885 ``false`` |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2886 Alias for ``ignore``. |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2887 |
27761
bf8b0796af2e
help: label windows config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27760
diff
changeset
|
2888 .. container:: windows |
27758
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2889 |
6a63fd8dd486
help: split config ui.portablefilenames
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27746
diff
changeset
|
2890 On Windows, this configuration option is ignored and the command aborted. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2891 |
40478
86dfae98a3a2
merge-tools: when calling external merge tool, describe the resolve inputs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
40421
diff
changeset
|
2892 ``pre-merge-tool-output-template`` |
45768
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
2893 (DEPRECATED) Use ``command-template.pre-merge-tool-output`` instead. |
40478
86dfae98a3a2
merge-tools: when calling external merge tool, describe the resolve inputs
Kyle Lippincott <spectral@google.com>
parents:
40421
diff
changeset
|
2894 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2895 ``quiet`` |
27759
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2896 Reduce the amount of output printed. |
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2897 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2898 |
41492
02186c6871ac
status: introduce higher-level ui.relative-paths
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
2899 ``relative-paths`` |
02186c6871ac
status: introduce higher-level ui.relative-paths
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
2900 Prefer relative paths in the UI. |
02186c6871ac
status: introduce higher-level ui.relative-paths
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
41207
diff
changeset
|
2901 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2902 ``remotecmd`` |
27759
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2903 Remote command to use for clone/push/pull operations. |
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2904 (default: ``hg``) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2905 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2906 ``report_untrusted`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2907 Warn if a ``.hg/hgrc`` file is ignored due to not being owned by a |
27759
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2908 trusted user or group. |
335167aab197
help: move config default marking to its own line
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27758
diff
changeset
|
2909 (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2910 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2911 ``slash`` |
35445
b86f52426396
help: deprecate ui.slash in favor of slashpath template filter (issue5572)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
35431
diff
changeset
|
2912 (Deprecated. Use ``slashpath`` template filter instead.) |
b86f52426396
help: deprecate ui.slash in favor of slashpath template filter (issue5572)
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
35431
diff
changeset
|
2913 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2914 Display paths using a slash (``/``) as the path separator. This |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2915 only makes a difference on systems where the default path |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2916 separator is not the slash character (e.g. Windows uses the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2917 backslash character (``\``)). |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2918 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2919 |
24663
7d01371e6358
commands: add ui.statuscopies config knob
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
24542
diff
changeset
|
2920 ``statuscopies`` |
7d01371e6358
commands: add ui.statuscopies config knob
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
24542
diff
changeset
|
2921 Display copies in the status command. |
7d01371e6358
commands: add ui.statuscopies config knob
Mathias De Maré <mathias.demare@gmail.com>
parents:
24542
diff
changeset
|
2922 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2923 ``ssh`` |
26278 | 2924 Command to use for SSH connections. (default: ``ssh``) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2925 |
35108
8b1c887d52e7
sshpeer: add a configurable hint for the ssh error message
Zuzanna Mroczek <zuza@fb.com>
parents:
35038
diff
changeset
|
2926 ``ssherrorhint`` |
8b1c887d52e7
sshpeer: add a configurable hint for the ssh error message
Zuzanna Mroczek <zuza@fb.com>
parents:
35038
diff
changeset
|
2927 A hint shown to the user in the case of SSH error (e.g. |
8b1c887d52e7
sshpeer: add a configurable hint for the ssh error message
Zuzanna Mroczek <zuza@fb.com>
parents:
35038
diff
changeset
|
2928 ``Please see http://company/internalwiki/ssh.html``) |
8b1c887d52e7
sshpeer: add a configurable hint for the ssh error message
Zuzanna Mroczek <zuza@fb.com>
parents:
35038
diff
changeset
|
2929 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2930 ``strict`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2931 Require exact command names, instead of allowing unambiguous |
26279 | 2932 abbreviations. (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2933 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2934 ``style`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2935 Name of style to use for command output. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2936 |
26263
bf2bfc6f45fb
traceback: allow providing a local support contact point
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
26225
diff
changeset
|
2937 ``supportcontact`` |
26313
e8afd380c576
help: copy-edit description of ui.supportcontact
Kevin Bullock <kbullock@ringworld.org>
parents:
26282
diff
changeset
|
2938 A URL where users should report a Mercurial traceback. Use this if you are a |
e8afd380c576
help: copy-edit description of ui.supportcontact
Kevin Bullock <kbullock@ringworld.org>
parents:
26282
diff
changeset
|
2939 large organisation with its own Mercurial deployment process and crash |
e8afd380c576
help: copy-edit description of ui.supportcontact
Kevin Bullock <kbullock@ringworld.org>
parents:
26282
diff
changeset
|
2940 reports should be addressed to your internal support. |
26263
bf2bfc6f45fb
traceback: allow providing a local support contact point
Pierre-Yves David <pierre-yves.david@fb.com>
parents:
26225
diff
changeset
|
2941 |
29070
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2942 ``textwidth`` |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2943 Maximum width of help text. A longer line generated by ``hg help`` or |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2944 ``hg subcommand --help`` will be broken after white space to get this |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2945 width or the terminal width, whichever comes first. |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2946 A non-positive value will disable this and the terminal width will be |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2947 used. (default: 78) |
29a7d591ff42
ui: add new config option for help text width
Jun Wu <quark@fb.com>
parents:
29060
diff
changeset
|
2948 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2949 ``timeout`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2950 The timeout used when a lock is held (in seconds), a negative value |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2951 means no timeout. (default: 600) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2952 |
35209
9153871d50e0
lock: allow to configure when the lock messages are displayed
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35108
diff
changeset
|
2953 ``timeout.warn`` |
9153871d50e0
lock: allow to configure when the lock messages are displayed
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35108
diff
changeset
|
2954 Time (in seconds) before a warning is printed about held lock. A negative |
9153871d50e0
lock: allow to configure when the lock messages are displayed
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35108
diff
changeset
|
2955 value means no warning. (default: 0) |
9153871d50e0
lock: allow to configure when the lock messages are displayed
Boris Feld <boris.feld@octobus.net>
parents:
35108
diff
changeset
|
2956 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2957 ``traceback`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2958 Mercurial always prints a traceback when an unknown exception |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2959 occurs. Setting this to True will make Mercurial print a traceback |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2960 on all exceptions, even those recognized by Mercurial (such as |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2961 IOError or MemoryError). (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2962 |
32872
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2963 ``tweakdefaults`` |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2964 |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2965 By default Mercurial's behavior changes very little from release |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2966 to release, but over time the recommended config settings |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2967 shift. Enable this config to opt in to get automatic tweaks to |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2968 Mercurial's behavior over time. This config setting will have no |
40299
3570adf20d91
help: fix a missing quote character in ui.tweakdefaults
Matt Harbison <matt_harbison@yahoo.com>
parents:
40043
diff
changeset
|
2969 effect if ``HGPLAIN`` is set or ``HGPLAINEXCEPT`` is set and does |
32872
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2970 not include ``tweakdefaults``. (default: False) |
9fcb6df413c9
ui: add support for a tweakdefaults knob
Augie Fackler <augie@google.com>
parents:
32851
diff
changeset
|
2971 |
40421
e928bedf0919
help: describe what ui.tweakdefaults changes, concretely
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
40419
diff
changeset
|
2972 It currently means:: |
e928bedf0919
help: describe what ui.tweakdefaults changes, concretely
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
40419
diff
changeset
|
2973 |
e928bedf0919
help: describe what ui.tweakdefaults changes, concretely
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
40419
diff
changeset
|
2974 .. tweakdefaultsmarker |
e928bedf0919
help: describe what ui.tweakdefaults changes, concretely
Valentin Gatien-Baron <vgatien-baron@janestreet.com>
parents:
40419
diff
changeset
|
2975 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2976 ``username`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2977 The committer of a changeset created when running "commit". |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2978 Typically a person's name and email address, e.g. ``Fred Widget |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2979 <fred@example.com>``. Environment variables in the |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2980 username are expanded. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
2981 |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2982 (default: ``$EMAIL`` or ``username@hostname``. If the username in |
27552
20589d3bda6d
help: remove stray double spaces from config help
timeless <timeless@mozdev.org>
parents:
27551
diff
changeset
|
2983 hgrc is empty, e.g. if the system admin set ``username =`` in the |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2984 system hgrc, it has to be specified manually or in a different |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2985 hgrc file) |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
2986 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2987 ``verbose`` |
26279 | 2988 Increase the amount of output printed. (default: False) |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2989 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
2990 |
45765
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2991 ``command-templates`` |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2992 --------------------- |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2993 |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2994 Templates used for customizing the output of commands. |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
2995 |
45766
1f7c077e0640
config: rename ui.graphnodetemplate to command-templates.graphnode
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45765
diff
changeset
|
2996 ``graphnode`` |
1f7c077e0640
config: rename ui.graphnodetemplate to command-templates.graphnode
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45765
diff
changeset
|
2997 The template used to print changeset nodes in an ASCII revision graph. |
1f7c077e0640
config: rename ui.graphnodetemplate to command-templates.graphnode
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45765
diff
changeset
|
2998 (default: ``{graphnode}``) |
1f7c077e0640
config: rename ui.graphnodetemplate to command-templates.graphnode
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45765
diff
changeset
|
2999 |
45765
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
3000 ``log`` |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
3001 Template string for commands that print changesets. |
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
3002 |
45767
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3003 ``mergemarker`` |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3004 The template used to print the commit description next to each conflict |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3005 marker during merge conflicts. See :hg:`help templates` for the template |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3006 format. |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3007 |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3008 Defaults to showing the hash, tags, branches, bookmarks, author, and |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3009 the first line of the commit description. |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3010 |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3011 If you use non-ASCII characters in names for tags, branches, bookmarks, |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3012 authors, and/or commit descriptions, you must pay attention to encodings of |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3013 managed files. At template expansion, non-ASCII characters use the encoding |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3014 specified by the ``--encoding`` global option, ``HGENCODING`` or other |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3015 environment variables that govern your locale. If the encoding of the merge |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3016 markers is different from the encoding of the merged files, |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3017 serious problems may occur. |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3018 |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3019 Can be overridden per-merge-tool, see the ``[merge-tools]`` section. |
40411ad2f5d2
config: rename ui.mergemarkertemplate to command-templates.mergemarker
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45766
diff
changeset
|
3020 |
45866
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3021 ``oneline-summary`` |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3022 A template used by `hg rebase` and other commands for showing a one-line |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3023 summary of a commit. If the template configured here is longer than one |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3024 line, then only the first line is used. |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3025 |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3026 The template can be overridden per command by defining a template in |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3027 `oneline-summary.<command>`, where `<command>` can be e.g. "rebase". |
996cd73431a3
help: document the new [command-templates] config section
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45768
diff
changeset
|
3028 |
45768
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3029 ``pre-merge-tool-output`` |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3030 A template that is printed before executing an external merge tool. This can |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3031 be used to print out additional context that might be useful to have during |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3032 the conflict resolution, such as the description of the various commits |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3033 involved or bookmarks/tags. |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3034 |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3035 Additional information is available in the ``local`, ``base``, and ``other`` |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3036 dicts. For example: ``{local.label}``, ``{base.name}``, or |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3037 ``{other.islink}``. |
5effb1992c17
config: move ui.pre-merge-tool-output-template into [command-templates]
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45767
diff
changeset
|
3038 |
45765
ed84a4d48910
config: add a new [command-templates] section for templates defined by hg
Martin von Zweigbergk <martinvonz@google.com>
parents:
45124
diff
changeset
|
3039 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3040 ``web`` |
17267
979b107eaea2
doc: unify section level between help topics
FUJIWARA Katsunori <foozy@lares.dti.ne.jp>
parents:
17251
diff
changeset
|
3041 ------- |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3042 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3043 Web interface configuration. The settings in this section apply to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3044 both the builtin webserver (started by :hg:`serve`) and the script you |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3045 run through a webserver (``hgweb.cgi`` and the derivatives for FastCGI |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3046 and WSGI). |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3047 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3048 The Mercurial webserver does no authentication (it does not prompt for |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3049 usernames and passwords to validate *who* users are), but it does do |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3050 authorization (it grants or denies access for *authenticated users* |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3051 based on settings in this section). You must either configure your |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3052 webserver to do authentication for you, or disable the authorization |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3053 checks. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3054 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3055 For a quick setup in a trusted environment, e.g., a private LAN, where |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3056 you want it to accept pushes from anybody, you can use the following |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3057 command line:: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3058 |
35038
6ef744a7df65
config: rename allow_push to allow-push
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
35037
diff
changeset
|
3059 $ hg --config web.allow-push=* --config web.push_ssl=False serve |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3060 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3061 Note that this will allow anybody to push anything to the server and |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3062 that this should not be used for public servers. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3063 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3064 The full set of options is: |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3065 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3066 ``accesslog`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3067 Where to output the access log. (default: stdout) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3068 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3069 ``address`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3070 Interface address to bind to. (default: all) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3071 |
38215
f715faeaceee
config: rename allow_archive to allow-archive
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
38100
diff
changeset
|
3072 ``allow-archive`` |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3073 List of archive format (bz2, gz, zip) allowed for downloading. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3074 (default: empty) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3075 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3076 ``allowbz2`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3077 (DEPRECATED) Whether to allow .tar.bz2 downloading of repository |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3078 revisions. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3079 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3080 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3081 ``allowgz`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3082 (DEPRECATED) Whether to allow .tar.gz downloading of repository |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3083 revisions. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3084 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3085 |
35037
da5d5ea7d696
config: rename allowpull to allow-pull
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
34989
diff
changeset
|
3086 ``allow-pull`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3087 Whether to allow pulling from the repository. (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3088 |
35038
6ef744a7df65
config: rename allow_push to allow-push
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
35037
diff
changeset
|
3089 ``allow-push`` |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3090 Whether to allow pushing to the repository. If empty or not set, |
26181
c16f071f048e
help/config: reword allow_push to fix grammar
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26180
diff
changeset
|
3091 pushing is not allowed. If the special value ``*``, any remote |
c16f071f048e
help/config: reword allow_push to fix grammar
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26180
diff
changeset
|
3092 user can push, including unauthenticated users. Otherwise, the |
c16f071f048e
help/config: reword allow_push to fix grammar
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26180
diff
changeset
|
3093 remote user must have been authenticated, and the authenticated |
c16f071f048e
help/config: reword allow_push to fix grammar
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26180
diff
changeset
|
3094 user name must be present in this list. The contents of the |
35038
6ef744a7df65
config: rename allow_push to allow-push
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
35037
diff
changeset
|
3095 allow-push list are examined after the deny_push list. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3096 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3097 ``allow_read`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3098 If the user has not already been denied repository access due to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3099 the contents of deny_read, this list determines whether to grant |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3100 repository access to the user. If this list is not empty, and the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3101 user is unauthenticated or not present in the list, then access is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3102 denied for the user. If the list is empty or not set, then access |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3103 is permitted to all users by default. Setting allow_read to the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3104 special value ``*`` is equivalent to it not being set (i.e. access |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3105 is permitted to all users). The contents of the allow_read list are |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3106 examined after the deny_read list. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3107 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3108 ``allowzip`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3109 (DEPRECATED) Whether to allow .zip downloading of repository |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3110 revisions. This feature creates temporary files. |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3111 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3112 |
17933
8243dd66e0e3
webcommands: allow hgweb's archive to recurse into subrepos
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
17685
diff
changeset
|
3113 ``archivesubrepos`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3114 Whether to recurse into subrepositories when archiving. |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3115 (default: False) |
17933
8243dd66e0e3
webcommands: allow hgweb's archive to recurse into subrepos
Jordi Gutiérrez Hermoso <jordigh@octave.org>
parents:
17685
diff
changeset
|
3116 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3117 ``baseurl`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3118 Base URL to use when publishing URLs in other locations, so |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3119 third-party tools like email notification hooks can construct |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3120 URLs. Example: ``http://hgserver/repos/``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3121 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3122 ``cacerts`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3123 Path to file containing a list of PEM encoded certificate |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3124 authority certificates. Environment variables and ``~user`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3125 constructs are expanded in the filename. If specified on the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3126 client, then it will verify the identity of remote HTTPS servers |
16399
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3127 with these certificates. |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3128 |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3129 To disable SSL verification temporarily, specify ``--insecure`` from |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3130 command line. |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3131 |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3132 You can use OpenSSL's CA certificate file if your platform has |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3133 one. On most Linux systems this will be |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3134 ``/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt``. Otherwise you will have to |
7416ce2c7887
help: fix indentation on cacert (issue3350)
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
16392
diff
changeset
|
3135 generate this file manually. The form must be as follows:: |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3136 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3137 -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE----- |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3138 ... (certificate in base64 PEM encoding) ... |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3139 -----END CERTIFICATE----- |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3140 -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE----- |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3141 ... (certificate in base64 PEM encoding) ... |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3142 -----END CERTIFICATE----- |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3143 |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3144 ``cache`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3145 Whether to support caching in hgweb. (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3146 |
25853
81802d1355ac
hgweb: document web.certificates option
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25691
diff
changeset
|
3147 ``certificate`` |
81802d1355ac
hgweb: document web.certificates option
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25691
diff
changeset
|
3148 Certificate to use when running :hg:`serve`. |
81802d1355ac
hgweb: document web.certificates option
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
25691
diff
changeset
|
3149 |
16570
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3150 ``collapse`` |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3151 With ``descend`` enabled, repositories in subdirectories are shown at |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3152 a single level alongside repositories in the current path. With |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3153 ``collapse`` also enabled, repositories residing at a deeper level than |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3154 the current path are grouped behind navigable directory entries that |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3155 lead to the locations of these repositories. In effect, this setting |
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3156 collapses each collection of repositories found within a subdirectory |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3157 into a single entry for that subdirectory. (default: False) |
16570
63f10a163017
help: added description for the web.collapse setting
Paul Boddie <paul@boddie.org.uk>
parents:
16549
diff
changeset
|
3158 |
17316
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3159 ``comparisoncontext`` |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3160 Number of lines of context to show in side-by-side file comparison. If |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3161 negative or the value ``full``, whole files are shown. (default: 5) |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3162 |
17316
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3163 This setting can be overridden by a ``context`` request parameter to the |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3164 ``comparison`` command, taking the same values. |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3165 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3166 ``contact`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3167 Name or email address of the person in charge of the repository. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3168 (default: ui.username or ``$EMAIL`` or "unknown" if unset or empty) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3169 |
30766
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3170 ``csp`` |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3171 Send a ``Content-Security-Policy`` HTTP header with this value. |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3172 |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3173 The value may contain a special string ``%nonce%``, which will be replaced |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3174 by a randomly-generated one-time use value. If the value contains |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3175 ``%nonce%``, ``web.cache`` will be disabled, as caching undermines the |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3176 one-time property of the nonce. This nonce will also be inserted into |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3177 ``<script>`` elements containing inline JavaScript. |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3178 |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3179 Note: lots of HTML content sent by the server is derived from repository |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3180 data. Please consider the potential for malicious repository data to |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3181 "inject" itself into generated HTML content as part of your security |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3182 threat model. |
d7bf7d2bd5ab
hgweb: support Content Security Policy
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
30764
diff
changeset
|
3183 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3184 ``deny_push`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3185 Whether to deny pushing to the repository. If empty or not set, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3186 push is not denied. If the special value ``*``, all remote users are |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3187 denied push. Otherwise, unauthenticated users are all denied, and |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3188 any authenticated user name present in this list is also denied. The |
35038
6ef744a7df65
config: rename allow_push to allow-push
David Demelier <markand@malikania.fr>
parents:
35037
diff
changeset
|
3189 contents of the deny_push list are examined before the allow-push list. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3190 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3191 ``deny_read`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3192 Whether to deny reading/viewing of the repository. If this list is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3193 not empty, unauthenticated users are all denied, and any |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3194 authenticated user name present in this list is also denied access to |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3195 the repository. If set to the special value ``*``, all remote users |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3196 are denied access (rarely needed ;). If deny_read is empty or not set, |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3197 the determination of repository access depends on the presence and |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3198 content of the allow_read list (see description). If both |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3199 deny_read and allow_read are empty or not set, then access is |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3200 permitted to all users by default. If the repository is being |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3201 served via hgwebdir, denied users will not be able to see it in |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3202 the list of repositories. The contents of the deny_read list have |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3203 priority over (are examined before) the contents of the allow_read |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3204 list. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3205 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3206 ``descend`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3207 hgwebdir indexes will not descend into subdirectories. Only repositories |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3208 directly in the current path will be shown (other repositories are still |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3209 available from the index corresponding to their containing path). |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3210 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3211 ``description`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3212 Textual description of the repository's purpose or contents. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3213 (default: "unknown") |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3214 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3215 ``encoding`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3216 Character encoding name. (default: the current locale charset) |
26177 | 3217 Example: "UTF-8". |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3218 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3219 ``errorlog`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3220 Where to output the error log. (default: stderr) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3221 |
17316
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3222 ``guessmime`` |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3223 Control MIME types for raw download of file content. |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3224 Set to True to let hgweb guess the content type from the file |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3225 extension. This will serve HTML files as ``text/html`` and might |
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3226 allow cross-site scripting attacks when serving untrusted |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3227 repositories. (default: False) |
17202
1ae119269ddc
hgweb: side-by-side comparison functionality
wujek srujek
parents:
16585
diff
changeset
|
3228 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3229 ``hidden`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3230 Whether to hide the repository in the hgwebdir index. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3231 (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3232 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3233 ``ipv6`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3234 Whether to use IPv6. (default: False) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3235 |
29471
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3236 ``labels`` |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3237 List of string *labels* associated with the repository. |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3238 |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3239 Labels are exposed as a template keyword and can be used to customize |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3240 output. e.g. the ``index`` template can group or filter repositories |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3241 by labels and the ``summary`` template can display additional content |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3242 if a specific label is present. |
c4fc33c477da
hgweb: expose list of per-repo labels to templates
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
29459
diff
changeset
|
3243 |
14938
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3244 ``logoimg`` |
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3245 File name of the logo image that some templates display on each page. |
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3246 The file name is relative to ``staticurl``. That is, the full path to |
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3247 the logo image is "staticurl/logoimg". |
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3248 If unset, ``hglogo.png`` will be used. |
ec18cd254156
help: add "web/logoimg" setting description
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
14891
diff
changeset
|
3249 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3250 ``logourl`` |
26421
4b0fc75f9403
urls: bulk-change primary website URLs
Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>
parents:
26365
diff
changeset
|
3251 Base URL to use for logos. If unset, ``https://mercurial-scm.org/`` |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3252 will be used. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3253 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3254 ``maxchanges`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3255 Maximum number of changes to list on the changelog. (default: 10) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3256 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3257 ``maxfiles`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3258 Maximum number of files to list per changeset. (default: 10) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3259 |
17317
0b8272274b56
help/config.txt: document web.maxshortchanges
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17316
diff
changeset
|
3260 ``maxshortchanges`` |
0b8272274b56
help/config.txt: document web.maxshortchanges
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17316
diff
changeset
|
3261 Maximum number of changes to list on the shortlog, graph or filelog |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3262 pages. (default: 60) |
17317
0b8272274b56
help/config.txt: document web.maxshortchanges
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17316
diff
changeset
|
3263 |
17316
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3264 ``name`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3265 Repository name to use in the web interface. |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3266 (default: current working directory) |
17316
8cf995a6dcb0
help/config.txt: reorder [web] options
Patrick Mezard <patrick@mezard.eu>
parents:
17267
diff
changeset
|
3267 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3268 ``port`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3269 Port to listen on. (default: 8000) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3270 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3271 ``prefix`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3272 Prefix path to serve from. (default: '' (server root)) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3273 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3274 ``push_ssl`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3275 Whether to require that inbound pushes be transported over SSL to |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3276 prevent password sniffing. (default: True) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3277 |
26072
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3278 ``refreshinterval`` |
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3279 How frequently directory listings re-scan the filesystem for new |
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3280 repositories, in seconds. This is relevant when wildcards are used |
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3281 to define paths. Depending on how much filesystem traversal is |
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3282 required, refreshing may negatively impact performance. |
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3283 |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3284 Values less than or equal to 0 always refresh. |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3285 (default: 20) |
26072
06320fb11699
hgweb: make refresh interval configurable
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
25853
diff
changeset
|
3286 |
37009
5890e5872f36
hgweb: allow defining Server response header for HTTP server
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
36696
diff
changeset
|
3287 ``server-header`` |
5890e5872f36
hgweb: allow defining Server response header for HTTP server
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
36696
diff
changeset
|
3288 Value for HTTP ``Server`` response header. |
5890e5872f36
hgweb: allow defining Server response header for HTTP server
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
36696
diff
changeset
|
3289 |
39792
ff0060d2a099
help: document web.static config
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
39722
diff
changeset
|
3290 ``static`` |
ff0060d2a099
help: document web.static config
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
39722
diff
changeset
|
3291 Directory where static files are served from. |
ff0060d2a099
help: document web.static config
Yuya Nishihara <yuya@tcha.org>
parents:
39722
diff
changeset
|
3292 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3293 ``staticurl`` |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3294 Base URL to use for static files. If unset, static files (e.g. the |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3295 hgicon.png favicon) will be served by the CGI script itself. Use |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3296 this setting to serve them directly with the HTTP server. |
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3297 Example: ``http://hgserver/static/``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3298 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3299 ``stripes`` |
17424
e7cfe3587ea4
fix trivial spelling errors
Mads Kiilerich <mads@kiilerich.com>
parents:
17317
diff
changeset
|
3300 How many lines a "zebra stripe" should span in multi-line output. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3301 Set to 0 to disable. (default: 1) |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3302 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3303 ``style`` |
22549
b1fc7ea5bb01
help: update help for hgweb template and style (issue4373)
Arun Chandrasekaran <visionofarun@gmail.com>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
3304 Which template map style to use. The available options are the names of |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3305 subdirectories in the HTML templates path. (default: ``paper``) |
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3306 Example: ``monoblue``. |
14458
c62b3b74f1d2
help/config: separate terms with a blank line
Martin Geisler <mg@lazybytes.net>
parents:
14457
diff
changeset
|
3307 |
14456
ff4126ce9301
help: move part of hgrc.5 man page config help topic
Yun Lee <yun.lee.bj@gmail.com>
parents:
13955
diff
changeset
|
3308 ``templates`` |
22549
b1fc7ea5bb01
help: update help for hgweb template and style (issue4373)
Arun Chandrasekaran <visionofarun@gmail.com>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
3309 Where to find the HTML templates. The default path to the HTML templates |
b1fc7ea5bb01
help: update help for hgweb template and style (issue4373)
Arun Chandrasekaran <visionofarun@gmail.com>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
3310 can be obtained from ``hg debuginstall``. |
18628
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3311 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3312 ``websub`` |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3313 ---------- |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3314 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3315 Web substitution filter definition. You can use this section to |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3316 define a set of regular expression substitution patterns which |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3317 let you automatically modify the hgweb server output. |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3318 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3319 The default hgweb templates only apply these substitution patterns |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3320 on the revision description fields. You can apply them anywhere |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3321 you want when you create your own templates by adding calls to the |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3322 "websub" filter (usually after calling the "escape" filter). |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3323 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3324 This can be used, for example, to convert issue references to links |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3325 to your issue tracker, or to convert "markdown-like" syntax into |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3326 HTML (see the examples below). |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3327 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3328 Each entry in this section names a substitution filter. |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3329 The value of each entry defines the substitution expression itself. |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3330 The websub expressions follow the old interhg extension syntax, |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3331 which in turn imitates the Unix sed replacement syntax:: |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3332 |
18958
c3b920980f22
spelling: fix typos and spelling errors
Mads Kiilerich <madski@unity3d.com>
parents:
18888
diff
changeset
|
3333 patternname = s/SEARCH_REGEX/REPLACE_EXPRESSION/[i] |
18628
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3334 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3335 You can use any separator other than "/". The final "i" is optional |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3336 and indicates that the search must be case insensitive. |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3337 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3338 Examples:: |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3339 |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3340 [websub] |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3341 issues = s|issue(\d+)|<a href="http://bts.example.org/issue\1">issue\1</a>|i |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3342 italic = s/\b_(\S+)_\b/<i>\1<\/i>/ |
52305554fd6e
hgweb: apply the websub filter to revision descriptions
Angel Ezquerra <angel.ezquerra@gmail.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3343 bold = s/\*\b(\S+)\b\*/<b>\1<\/b>/ |
18652 | 3344 |
18636
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3345 ``worker`` |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3346 ---------- |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3347 |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3348 Parallel master/worker configuration. We currently perform working |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3349 directory updates in parallel on Unix-like systems, which greatly |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3350 helps performance. |
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3351 |
35431
471918fa7f46
workers: add config to enable/diable workers
Wojciech Lis <wlis@fb.com>
parents:
35261
diff
changeset
|
3352 ``enabled`` |
471918fa7f46
workers: add config to enable/diable workers
Wojciech Lis <wlis@fb.com>
parents:
35261
diff
changeset
|
3353 Whether to enable workers code to be used. |
471918fa7f46
workers: add config to enable/diable workers
Wojciech Lis <wlis@fb.com>
parents:
35261
diff
changeset
|
3354 (default: true) |
471918fa7f46
workers: add config to enable/diable workers
Wojciech Lis <wlis@fb.com>
parents:
35261
diff
changeset
|
3355 |
18636
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3356 ``numcpus`` |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3357 Number of CPUs to use for parallel operations. A zero or |
18636
dcb27c153a40
worker: estimate whether it's worth running a task in parallel
Bryan O'Sullivan <bryano@fb.com>
parents:
18548
diff
changeset
|
3358 negative value is treated as ``use the default``. |
26182
6832ba528d1a
help/config: make defaults consistent
timeless@mozdev.org
parents:
26181
diff
changeset
|
3359 (default: 4 or the number of CPUs on the system, whichever is larger) |
27895
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3360 |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3361 ``backgroundclose`` |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3362 Whether to enable closing file handles on background threads during certain |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3363 operations. Some platforms aren't very efficient at closing file |
27986
a58378983687
help: fix typo in backgroundclose documentation
André Sintzoff <andre.sintzoff@gmail.com>
parents:
27960
diff
changeset
|
3364 handles that have been written or appended to. By performing file closing |
27895
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3365 on background threads, file write rate can increase substantially. |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3366 (default: true on Windows, false elsewhere) |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3367 |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3368 ``backgroundcloseminfilecount`` |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3369 Minimum number of files required to trigger background file closing. |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3370 Operations not writing this many files won't start background close |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3371 threads. |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3372 (default: 2048) |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3373 |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3374 ``backgroundclosemaxqueue`` |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3375 The maximum number of opened file handles waiting to be closed in the |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3376 background. This option only has an effect if ``backgroundclose`` is |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3377 enabled. |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3378 (default: 384) |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3379 |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3380 ``backgroundclosethreadcount`` |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3381 Number of threads to process background file closes. Only relevant if |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3382 ``backgroundclose`` is enabled. |
2d6a89e79b48
scmutil: support background file closing
Gregory Szorc <gregory.szorc@gmail.com>
parents:
27889
diff
changeset
|
3383 (default: 4) |